*** empty log message ***
[bpt/emacs.git] / etc / NEWS
CommitLineData
c67de8ba 1GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
31e0fbdd 2Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
a933dad1
DL
3See the end for copying conditions.
4
5Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
3787e12e 6For older news, see the file ONEWS
5a2c89c3
JL
7You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
8`view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
a933dad1 9
ad8d610b
KS
10Temporary note:
11 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
12 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
13When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
1a0b9ae4 14so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
ad8d610b 15
05197f40 16\f
d278091b 17* Installation Changes in Emacs 21.4
76fb24bb 18
1ebd4f78
JB
19** Emacs includes now support for loading image libraries on demand.
20(Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
21the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
22setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
23
bc83b22b 24---
b687047c
WL
25** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the following
26 languages: Brasilian, Bulgarian, Chinese (both with simplified and
27 traditional characters), French, and Italian. Type `C-u C-h t' to
28 choose one of them in case your language setup doesn't automatically
29 select the right one.
bc83b22b 30
0571f2d8 31** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
7bea57c9
DL
32when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
33provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
0571f2d8 34
2b6bb1f2 35---
d2a53bb7
PJ
36** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
37
4208da83
SM
38** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
39
2b6bb1f2 40---
76fb24bb
PJ
41** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
42`--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
43installed programs.
44
2b6bb1f2 45---
81f755ae 46** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
672ab90b
CW
47scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
48place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
49configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
50to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
5167cfda
CW
51to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
52in each user's home directory.
81f755ae 53
cd7d2d9e
EZ
54---
55** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
56You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
57Emacs with Leim.
58
4e5cdb4f
KS
59+++
60** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
61
62The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
63Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
64Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
65accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
66
67---
68** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
69the distribution.
70
71This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
72together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
73item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
74(Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
75
c60ee5e7
JB
76** Support for Cygwin was added.
77
a17b3614 78---
1096bcc0
GM
79** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
80
84913e36
EZ
81---
82** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
83
82e119fb
EZ
84---
85** Support for MacOS X was added.
86See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
87
2b6bb1f2 88---
3fa4ac47 89** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
16927a56 90
d2d70cb6 91---
4e5cdb4f
KS
92** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
93
94---
d7107586
SM
95** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
96types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
4e5cdb4f
KS
97
98\f
99* Changes in Emacs 21.4
d2d70cb6 100
18819b0f
RS
101** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
102
4ac3afb9
EZ
103** In Outline mode, hide-body no longer hides lines at the top
104of the file that precede the first header line.
105
f3df1033
DP
106+++
107** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
108precedence over the file name. Likewise an <?xml or <!DOCTYPE declaration
c7eb99ce
DP
109will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new var
110`magic-mode-alist'.
f3df1033 111
3bfb0bff 112+++
31e931a5 113** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3bfb0bff
RS
114the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
115back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
116
010864ea
EZ
117+++
118** New functions `make-progress-reporter', `progress-reporter-update',
119`progress-reporter-force-update' and `progress-reporter-done' provide
120a simple and efficient way of printing progress messages to the user.
121
5086e75d
LT
122+++
123** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
124by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
125and `C-c C-r'.
126
4d894c98
RS
127+++
128** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
129suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
130
7d01236c 131+++
61b73aa4
LT
132** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
133in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
134
2ee3b79e
RS
135** global-whitespace-mode is a new alias for whitespace-global-mode.
136
dd0a3ea3
LT
137+++
138** There are now two new regular expression operators, \_< and \_>,
139for matching the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
140non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
141specified by the syntax table.
142
8758f42e
JB
143** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
144You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
145existing values. For example:
146
147 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
148
149will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
150irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
151
3fc3e0a6
JL
152** New features in evaluation commands
153
a1bcf785 154+++
3fc3e0a6
JL
155*** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
156the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
157
158*** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
159in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
160by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
161function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
162`eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
a7ab1711 163
9254ee5e
KH
164** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
165characters.
166
64a0fd20
KH
167** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
168in the current input method to input a character at point.
44251fad 169
f0529fe1
JB
170** Convenient commands to switch buffers in a cyclic order are C-x <left>
171(prev-buffer) and C-x <right> (next-buffer).
172
173** Commands winner-redo and winner-undo, from winner.el, are now bound to
174C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an incompatible change.
175
11d7bca4 176** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
85f6be54 177arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
bfd40f00
JB
178default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
179`help-default-arg-highlight'.
f0529fe1 180
21fb7588 181---
0dbc1dd0
LT
182** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
183option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
184except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
185controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
8248b4ad
LT
186overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
187
188The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
189support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
190
191`comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
d1b2b8cc 192read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
8248b4ad
LT
193lines, including any prompts.
194
195`comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
196read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
197part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
198and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
199not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
0dbc1dd0
LT
200`kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
201kill-ring, but does not delete it.
21fb7588 202
d88beab5
KS
203** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
204the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
205
d1b2b8cc 206** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
879054ea 207
c78bf503 208+++
a27ddfaf
KS
209** New command line option -Q.
210
211This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
212the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, the blinking
213cursor, and the fancy startup screen.
214
f8f853de
SM
215** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
216variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
217
4ba2fd66
LT
218** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
219before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
220supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
221
222** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
223If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
224mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
d1b2b8cc 225displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
4ba2fd66 226the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
d1b2b8cc 227just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
4ba2fd66
LT
228rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior may
229be mode dependent.
230
9f14953b
LT
231If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
232then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
233mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
234toggles this mode.
235
428b6b85
LT
236** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
237other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
238revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
239and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
d1b2b8cc 240mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
428b6b85
LT
241`revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
242decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
243that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
244work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
245
246** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
247Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
248control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
249which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
250only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
251
252** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
253buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
254mode.
255
d3a29dd8
DP
256** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
257
258Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
259recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
260red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
261(controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
262
e5c644da
DP
263Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
264This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
265This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
266
d3a29dd8
DP
267The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
268you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
269leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
270`compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
271that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
ecf4207f
SM
272
273The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
274
2a075e37
JL
275** Compilation mode enhancements:
276
4d894c98 277+++
2a075e37
JL
278*** New user option `compilation-environment'.
279This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
280compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
281subprocesses inherit.
282
283** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
284
285*** There's a new separate package grep.el.
286
287*** M-x grep has been adapted to new compile
ecf4207f
SM
288
289Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
d1b2b8cc 290can be saved and automatically revisited with the new Grep mode.
ecf4207f 291
2a075e37
JL
292*** Grep commands now have their own submenu and customization group.
293
294*** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
295`grep-scroll-output' can be used to override the corresponding
296compilation mode settings for grep commands.
297
298*** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
299buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
300--color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
301match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
302buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
303source line is highlighted.
304
305*** New key bindings in grep output window:
306SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
307previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
308the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
309other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
310previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
311file.
312
313** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
314specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
315in new face `next-error'.
316
2a223f35
EZ
317** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
318compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
319modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
320buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
321matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
322C-c C-f.
f5e9cb97 323
ecf4207f
SM
324** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
325
ee213e98
JL
326** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
327resync points in both windows.
328
2f9da07b
EZ
329** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
330This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
331the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
332using strokes as an input method.
333
23f87bed
MB
334** Gnus package
335
336*** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
337Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
338PGP/MIME.
339
340*** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
341See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
342
61d244ca
LH
343+++
344** Desktop package
345
346*** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, desktop-save-mode. Variable
347desktop-enable is obsolete. Customize desktop-save-mode to enable desktop
348saving.
349
350*** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
351buffer list.
352
353*** New commands:
354 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
355 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
356 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
357 it was loaded.
358
359*** New customizable variables:
360 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
361 killed.
362 - desktop-file-name-format.
363 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
364 - desktop-locals-to-save.
365 - desktop-globals-to-clear.
366 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp.
367
368*** New command line option --no-desktop
369
370*** New hooks:
371 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
372 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
373
b1faee6e
EZ
374---
375** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
376When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
377include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
378Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
379to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
380and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
381feature.
382
61042632
SM
383** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
384
385 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
386 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
387 % emacsclient -s foo file1
388 % emacsclient -s bar file2
389
ed2846bd 390+++
dcf0c8e0
KS
391** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
392(not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
393two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
394Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
395cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
396
397The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' may be set to nil to
398revert to the old behaviour of continuing such lines.
399
ed2846bd 400+++
b2b681f1
KS
401** The buffer boundaries (i.e. first and last line in the buffer) may
402now be marked with angle bitmaps in the fringes. In addition, up and
403down arrow bitmaps may be shown at the top and bottom of the left or
404right fringe if the window can be scrolled in either direction.
dcf0c8e0
KS
405
406This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
b2b681f1
KS
407`indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
408this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
409
410If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
f2a54fbc 411displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
b2b681f1 412
f2a54fbc
KS
413Value may also be an alist which specifies the presense and position
414of each bitmap individually.
b2b681f1 415
f2a54fbc
KS
416For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
417in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
418arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
419left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
dcf0c8e0 420
d18473b9
LT
421** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
422in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
423same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
424`help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
425keyboard oriented alternative.
426
427** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
428automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
429point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
430determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
431to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
432
433** New commands `scan-buf-next-region' and `scan-buf-previous-region'
434move to the start of the next (previous, respectively) region with
435non-nil help-echo property and display any help found there in the
436echo area, using `display-local-help'.
437
e5dadca7
LT
438+++
439** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
440preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
441hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
3f70fe82
LT
442preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
443hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
444enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
445anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
e5dadca7 446
cff5e534
SM
447** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
448On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
449
8fe7d8c8
RS
450+++
451** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
f8977ff3 452now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
8fe7d8c8
RS
453an interactively callable function.
454
455
668c2ab0
JB
456** sql changes.
457
458*** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
459SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
460buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
461session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
462SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
463
464The following values are supported:
465
466 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
467 db2 DB2
468 informix Informix
469 ingres Ingres
470 interbase Interbase
471 linter Linter
472 ms Microsoft
473 mysql MySQL
474 oracle Oracle
475 postgres Postgres
476 solid Solid
477 sqlite SQLite
478 sybase Sybase
479
480The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
481SQL mode indicator.
482
483The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
484your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
485`sql-product' to accomplish this.
486
2c2cd44f
SM
487ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
488
668c2ab0
JB
489*** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
490font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
491all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
492you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
493
494 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2c2cd44f 495 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
668c2ab0
JB
496
497*** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
498SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
499highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
500
501*** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
502Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
503sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
e4aaf69c 504osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
668c2ab0
JB
505are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
506terminated.
507
508If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
509called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
510credentials to authenticate the user.
511
2c2cd44f
SM
512*** Postgres support is enhanced.
513Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
514the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
515
516*** MySQL support is enhanced.
517Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
518
668c2ab0
JB
519*** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
520packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
521defaults.
522
523*** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
524appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
525`sql-product'.
526
80384936
RS
527** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
528with special modes such as Tar mode.
529
ee216b2c
KS
530** Enhancements to apropos commands:
531
d1b2b8cc 532*** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
ee216b2c
KS
533When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
534be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
535available.
536
537*** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
538to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
539number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
540regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
541match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
542matching item.
800bebe3 543
c6de56a0
RS
544+++
545** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
546since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
547the operating system or your X server.
548
549** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
d60f1316 550When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
668c2ab0 551restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
d60f1316
LT
552
553** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
554By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
555
a1bcf785
JL
556** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
557`insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
558
559** A prefix argument of C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-printifies the
560list starting after point.
561
ee213e98
JL
562** Dired mode:
563
564*** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
565dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
566introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
567
a1bcf785
JL
568*** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
569with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
570
571+++
572*** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
573of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
ee213e98
JL
574
575+++
576*** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
577control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
578by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
579too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
580doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
581special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
582
583+++
584*** Dired's v command now runs external viewers to view certain
585types of files. The variable `dired-view-command-alist' controls
586what external viewers to use and when.
587
588*** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
a1bcf785 589into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
ee213e98 590
61d244ca
LH
591+++
592** Dired-x:
593
594*** Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. The mode toggling
595command is bound to M-o. A new command dired-mark-omitted, bound to M-O,
596marks omitted files. The variable dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the
597mode toggling function instead.
598
8ab314f9
JL
599+++
600** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
601when the file name contains wildcard characters.
602
603+++
604** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
605when the file name contains wildcard characters.
606
607** FFAP
608
609+++
610*** New ffap commands and keybindings: C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
611C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
612C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
613C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
614
615---
616*** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default. C-x C-f passes
617it to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS argument, which visits
618multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
619
43ea9947 620** Info mode:
a1bcf785
JL
621
622*** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
623with the number appended to the *info* buffer name.
624
0dfddff5
JL
625*** Regexp isearch (C-M-s and C-M-r) can search through multiple nodes.
626Failed isearch wraps to the top/final node.
627
628*** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
629`Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
630search without prompting for a new search string.
631
a1bcf785
JL
632*** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
633
634*** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
635from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
636
637*** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
638Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
639possible matches.
640
641*** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
642the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
643arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
644
a1bcf785
JL
645*** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
646and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
647
648*** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
649references and following them calls `browse-url'.
650
d60f1316 651+++
43ea9947 652*** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
d60f1316
LT
653If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
654`Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
655
7dcac3a6
JL
656*** Images in Info pages are supported.
657Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
658Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
659version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
660
ee213e98
JL
661+++
662*** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
663
664---
665*** Info-index offers completion.
666
5d0ab731
JB
667** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
668'sql-sqlite'.
669
bf078377 670** BibTeX mode:
d528bff7 671*** The new command bibtex-url browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
e0dc0c55
SM
672point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
673
c20052b2
SM
674*** The new command bibtex-entry-update (bound to C-c C-u) updates
675an existing BibTeX entry.
e0dc0c55 676
bf078377 677*** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
e0dc0c55 678
bf078377
SM
679*** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
680`crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
e0dc0c55
SM
681for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
682scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
a6aa9850
KG
683automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
684bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
685
686*** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
687use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
688
689*** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
690automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
691
692*** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
693types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
694
695*** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
696point according to context (bound to M-tab).
697
698*** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
02c8032e
SM
699locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
700Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
a6aa9850
KG
701
702*** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
703individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
bf078377 704
02c8032e
SM
705*** The new variables bibtex-files and bibtex-file-path define a set
706of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
e0dc0c55 707
02c8032e 708*** The new command bibtex-validate-globally checks for duplicate keys
e0dc0c55
SM
709in multiple BibTeX files.
710
711*** The new command bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill pushes summary
712of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
713
6f8968c8
KS
714** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
715displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
716at the edges of the window.
717
bd9b2b20 718** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
6f8968c8
KS
719in addition to the individual display margin settings.
720
721Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
bd9b2b20 722horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
6f8968c8
KS
723or when the frame is resized.
724
fbe57420
KS
725** New functions frame-current-scroll-bars and window-current-scroll-bars.
726
727These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
fd940504 728horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
fbe57420 729
0074d3a0
JD
730---
731** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
732 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
733 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
734
2a89019f
SM
735** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
736
c67de8ba
DL
737** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
738speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
739
42f81f64
KS
740If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
741XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
742
a95cefd7 743** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
c64a682c
SM
744
745** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
746`file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
747
748** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
d1b2b8cc 749Emacs prompts her for confirmation.
c64a682c 750
347003be
DL
751** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
752
556621f6
NR
753** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
754and other common debugger commands.
755
1d1d1b1f
JB
756** recentf changes.
757
758The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
759enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
760automatic cleanup.
761
762With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
763specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
764example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
765recent list with different symbolic links.
766
767To follow naming convention, `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-flag'
768and `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag' respectively replace the
769misnamed options `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p' and
770`recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The old names remain available as
771aliases, but have been marked obsolete.
772
4cdf4bde
DL
773** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
774from the locale.
61cb0b53 775
5ab0ceed
RS
776** Init file changes
777
778You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
779~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
780
0ec6b206
SM
781** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
782
ff6a3bfb
RS
783** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
784 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
785 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
786 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
787 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
788 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
789
a1b4049d
BW
790** MH-E changes.
791
eccf9613 792Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
a1b4049d
BW
793version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
794
5b8b9fa7 795+++
175573ac
DL
796** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
797`--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
798expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
799
800** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
5b8b9fa7 801
f5d0cc77
RS
802+++
803** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
804When the file is maintained under version control, that information
805appears between the position information and the major mode.
2c37653c 806
957e7c38
RS
807** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
808against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
809
2e4e635a
RS
810+++
811** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
812for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
813top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
814control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
815set-fringe-style.
555c87d8 816
2e4e635a 817+++
d7b590b1
MR
818** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
819to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
820directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
821"~/".
822
2b6bb1f2 823+++
af7272b1
RS
824** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
825read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
d1b2b8cc
RS
826want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
827file.)
af7272b1 828
cc305a60
RS
829** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
830revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
831
8798ecdb
KH
832** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
833of a file.
834
dacec596 835---
4cdf4bde 836** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
dacec596
EZ
837
838Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
839ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
840See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
841
b03763f4
EZ
842---
843** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
844`buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
845in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
846
847`buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
848leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
d1b2b8cc 849If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
b03763f4
EZ
850shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
851and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
852
853`buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
854the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
855t, and the status is shown.
856
857Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
858the Buffers menu is regenerated.
859
2e4e635a 860+++
4d3eda1c 861** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
2e4e635a
RS
862now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
863specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
864faces.
4d3eda1c 865
b51dcd14 866** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
175573ac 867Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
4cdf4bde
DL
868Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
869Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
870automatically according to the locale.)
175573ac
DL
871
872** Indian support has been updated.
873The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
874assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
4cdf4bde
DL
875Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
876supported.
fc2938d1 877
813f3d41 878---
fc2938d1
DL
879** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
880ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
881vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
882latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
4cdf4bde
DL
883bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
884tamil-inscript.
fc2938d1 885
813f3d41
RS
886---
887** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
888in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
889Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
890
891---
fc2938d1
DL
892** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
893library. These include complete versions of most of those in
30955b19
EZ
894codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
895obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
896and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
897latter is used by GNU locales.
fc2938d1 898
347003be 899** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
66189a40
KH
900By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
901single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
902turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
903sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
904system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
905interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
347003be
DL
906You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
907`ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
908coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
742f8710 909one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
347003be 910The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
a4ac5b17 911
af3b9e47
KH
912** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
913Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
914
a4ac5b17
DL
915** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
916characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
917fontset appropriately.
fc2938d1
DL
918
919** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
a4ac5b17 920unicode.
fc2938d1 921
1c6576ab 922+++
a4ac5b17
DL
923** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
924Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
925the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
926Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
927sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
928translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
929mule-unicode-... ones.
930
d1b2b8cc 931By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
a4ac5b17
DL
932Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
933with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
934possible.
fc2938d1
DL
935
936You can force a more complete unification with the user option
937unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
938into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
a4ac5b17
DL
939mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
940will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
fc2938d1
DL
941
942** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
943either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
944when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
e9b9ec8b 945controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
8f9891ab 946
7443bd8e
KH
947** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
948coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
949(Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
950command.
951
2a1e884e 952---
2e4e635a 953** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
5a597a71
SM
954On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
955amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
956
ecb3b438
JD
957---
958** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
fb40303e 959be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
ecb3b438
JD
960
961---
fb40303e
JD
962** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
963ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
964
965---
966** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
967and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
968to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
ecb3b438 969
1394f7f5 970+++
fb40303e 971** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
1394f7f5
JD
972disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
973
cba71f24
JD
974+++
975** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
3a0ab7ec 976by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
cba71f24
JD
977the new dialog.
978
267bdad3
EZ
979+++
980** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
981The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
982default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
983cursor does.
984
23706d6c
KS
985+++
986** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
987now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
988
c0e48b0b
RS
989** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
990various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
991program files that include other program files.
992
993Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
994all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
995in them.
996
172f1af1
EZ
997---
998** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
999when Emacs visits them.
1000
2a1e884e 1001---
ded0c207
EZ
1002** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
1003
1004`mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
1005default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
1006automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
1007
b5d2c621
KH
1008** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1009requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1010Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1011and use the more appropriately result.
1012
63a4cd16
EZ
1013+++
1014** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
63a7fdcf
EZ
1015The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
1016the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
1017will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
1a667242 1018
63a7fdcf 1019The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
d1b2b8cc 1020hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
63a7fdcf
EZ
1021window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
1022window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
1023many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
1024gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
1025
813f3d41
RS
1026The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
1027`auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
1028
bf078377 1029** TeX modes:
a95cefd7 1030*** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2a1e884e 1031+++
0ec6b206 1032*** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
63bfbe6f
RS
1033by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
1034command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
1035TeX commands to use at startup.
0ec6b206
SM
1036*** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
1037and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
63bfbe6f 1038
c64a682c
SM
1039*** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
1040
2a1e884e 1041+++
b0ada147
RS
1042** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
1043to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
1044mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
1045different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
1046be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
1047feature is not enabled.
3996d07a 1048
62ce3608
KS
1049** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
1050select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
1051normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
1052the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
fa7f39ad 1053window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
62ce3608
KS
1054to give it focus.
1055
1c6576ab
RS
1056+++
1057** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
1058description various information about a character, including its
d6696bb6
KH
1059encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
1060widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
1061clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
c145bbb3 1062
81f755ae
CW
1063+++
1064** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1065search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1066`multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1067buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1068rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1069
1791907b
DK
1070** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
1071been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
1072in Indented-Text mode.
1073
1074** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
1075`query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
1076a match if part of it has a read-only property.
1077
1078** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
1079`replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
1080where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
1081time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
59035302
JL
1082`query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
1083to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
1084All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
1085replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
1086can be edited for each replacement.
1791907b 1087
a31a30b5
JL
1088** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
1089`query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
1090
1091** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
1092`query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
836c086b 1093
255ec1b0 1094+++
b2bd7aff
RS
1095** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1096is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1097can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1098mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1099also disable mouse highlighting.
90e87070 1100
26fb226b
KS
1101** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1102shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1103variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1104
2a1e884e 1105+++
fd42af9d
SM
1106** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
1107an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
1108font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
1109if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
1110trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
1111
236f1c76
EZ
1112+++
1113** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
1114Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
1115variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
1116prompt string.
1117
9a770d8d 1118+++
fd4f8b36
KS
1119** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
1120of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
1121the mode line of the currently selected window.
1122
89f8199f
KS
1123The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
1124the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
1125
2e4e635a 1126---
1f600b1b 1127** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
2e4e635a
RS
1128This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
1129as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
1130You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
1131it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
1132current date and time, current line and column number in the
1133mode-line.
1f600b1b 1134
2e4e635a 1135---
a9c6d330
PA
1136** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
1137
2a1e884e 1138+++
347003be 1139** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
2a1e884e 1140in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
7c961dc2 1141`display-time-mail-directory'.
2d4ef682 1142
a4fc6fc9
PJ
1143---
1144** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
1145
e58d8457 1146+++
5e101746 1147** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
e58d8457 1148M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
5e101746
RS
1149argument it toggles the mode.
1150
1151Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
1152that were replaced by turning on the mode.
1153
2e4e635a 1154+++
b54cfb55
CW
1155** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
1156arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
1157disables the splash screen; see also the variable
1158`inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
1159`inhibit-splash-screen').
1160
7cc8f35a
EZ
1161** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
1162
e0c124ce 1163+++
7cc8f35a 1164*** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
e0c124ce
EZ
1165mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1166terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1167database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1168set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1169terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1170when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1171in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1172user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1173
7cc8f35a
EZ
1174---
1175*** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1176than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1177256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1178the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1179all of these colors.
1180
11a365f9
EZ
1181+++
1182*** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1183faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1184256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
118588-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1186colors as on X.
1187
7cc8f35a
EZ
1188---
1189*** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1190
6625fc7d
EZ
1191+++
1192** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
1193
1194When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
1195`--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
1196whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
616d7a51 1197screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
6625fc7d 1198
2b6bb1f2 1199---
a8f57660 1200** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2b6bb1f2 1201automatically.
cb8d4d07 1202
2b6bb1f2 1203+++
eaffd16d 1204** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
4e3dd7cf
MB
1205modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1206like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1207otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1208
2b6bb1f2 1209+++
00b1ee61
RS
1210** Changes in C-h bindings:
1211
1212C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
1213
1214C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
1215 that do not change:
1216
1217C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
1218C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
1219
1220The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
1221have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
1222
93607efd
KS
1223C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
1224
1225- C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
1226 run by the key sequence.
1227
1228- C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
1229 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
1230 that command.
1231
1232For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
bf8dd4e3 1233to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
93607efd
KS
1234
1235- C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
1236 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
1237
1238- C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
1239 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
1240
1241- C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
1242 new-kill-line is on C-k
1243
e42d6474
EZ
1244+++
1245** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
1246To enable this feature, customize the new user option
1247`isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
1248constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
1249for details.
1250
2b6bb1f2 1251+++
a207b33c
RS
1252** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
1253making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
1254command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
1255bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
1256
e42d6474
EZ
1257+++
1258** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
1259at the end of a line.
1260
59035302
JL
1261+++
1262** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
1263Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
1264and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
1265
1266+++
dc29ba9b
JL
1267** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
1268`query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
1269search string used as the string to replace.
59035302 1270
2a075e37 1271+++
662b102f
KS
1272** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
1273history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
1274user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
2a075e37
JL
1275
1276+++
1277** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
1278If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
1279elements are deleted.
1280
2b6bb1f2 1281+++
d9f7eb77
RS
1282** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
1283be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
1284`yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
1285of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
1286
1c6576ab 1287+++
b54cfb55
CW
1288** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
1289M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
1290`Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
1291remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
1292
1c6576ab 1293+++
4e3dd7cf 1294** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
d1b2b8cc
RS
1295by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1296detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
4e3dd7cf
MB
1297When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1298unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1299command lines to be used than was possible before.
1300
1c6576ab 1301---
4e3dd7cf
MB
1302** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1303In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1304check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1305for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1306sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1307its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1308case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1309
3116d142 1310+++
c721078e
RS
1311** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1312the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1313You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1314under the "[State]" button.
1315
63db1bb3
MR
1316** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
1317point (no integers are allowed).
1318
2b6bb1f2
RS
1319+++
1320** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
4febb0e7
RS
1321counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
1322
2b6bb1f2 1323---
ca64d378 1324** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
a1e3dda0
RS
1325
1326*** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
1327 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
1328 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
1329 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
1330 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
1331
1332*** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
1333 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
1334 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
1335 (gud-finish).
1336
1337*** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
1338 (Java 1.1 jdb).
1339
1340*** The previous method of searching for source files has been
1341 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
1342 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
1343
1344 Added Customization Variables
1345
1346*** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
1347
1348*** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
1349 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
1350 java sources (previous method).
1351
1352*** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
1353 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
1354 is nil).
1355
1356 Minor Improvements
1357
9e94e254
SJ
1358*** The STARTTLS elisp wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
1359instead of the OpenSSL based "starttls" tool. For backwards
d1b2b8cc 1360compatibility, it prefers "starttls", but you can toggle
9e94e254
SJ
1361`starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
1362"starttls" tool).
1363
a1e3dda0
RS
1364*** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
1365
1c6576ab 1366+++
43a88bc1
SM
1367** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
1368to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
d29bf2fa 1369changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
43a88bc1 1370
1c6576ab 1371+++
111ed14e
SM
1372** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
1373the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
1374Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
1375is only rarely needed.
1376
1c6576ab 1377---
cce5462e
SM
1378** JIT-lock changes
1379*** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
8ea55f33
EZ
1380
1381If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
fbe51115 1382idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
8ea55f33
EZ
1383example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
1384only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
f67cc62e 1385
cce5462e
SM
1386*** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
1387
1388jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
1389jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
1390refontification takes place.
1391
cad113ae
KG
1392+++
1393** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
1394you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
d1b2b8cc
RS
1395C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region extends each time, so
1396you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC, for example.
1397This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to
6a2067b2
JL
1398a key. It also extends the region when the mark is active in Transient
1399Mark mode, regardless of the last command. To start a new region with
1400one of marking commands in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the
1401active region with C-g, or set the new mark with C-SPC.
6710ea06 1402
2b6bb1f2 1403+++
18f10eda
RS
1404** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
1405mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
1406region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
1407want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
2b6bb1f2
RS
1408ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
1409command only.
18f10eda 1410
2b6bb1f2
RS
1411One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
1412and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
1413This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
1414mark or the region.
32f665fa 1415
2b6bb1f2
RS
1416After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
1417deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
1418that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
1419C-g.
66aa61d8 1420
2b6bb1f2 1421+++
66aa61d8 1422** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
d1b2b8cc 1423previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
66aa61d8
KS
1424mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
1425
6a2067b2 1426** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
a31a30b5
JL
1427`beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
1428is already active in Transient Mark mode.
6a2067b2 1429
1c6576ab 1430+++
a474d59c
RS
1431** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1432C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1433switching to it.
7c425d82 1434
1c6576ab 1435+++
7c425d82
RS
1436** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
1437all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
1438affects the initial frame.
1439
efe459e4 1440+++
fbe51115
PJ
1441** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
1442With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
564b1f76
EZ
1443if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
1444paragraphs.
efe459e4 1445
1c6576ab 1446+++
b04dcf45
RS
1447** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1448have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1449directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1450directory listing into a buffer.
1451
1c6576ab 1452---
6710ea06
SM
1453** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1454(rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1455
cc563ece
KS
1456** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
1457wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
1458This behaviour can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1459mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1460
2b6bb1f2 1461+++
457c233a
DL
1462** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1463current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1464may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1465characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1466emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1467keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1468or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1469by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
16927a56 1470
3aa2f38a
RS
1471+++
1472** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
273a3930
EZ
1473automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
1474modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
1475can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
2bc8d7c8 1476according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
3aa2f38a 1477
1c6576ab 1478+++
830047fd
RS
1479** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
1480of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
1481appears in.
6c0b2643 1482
d5ec54b6
KS
1483** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
1484of the recognized cursor types.
c60ee5e7 1485
1c6576ab 1486---
758bf24f
GM
1487** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
1488controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
1489attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
1490
1698fb36
GM
1491+++
1492** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
1493convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
1494
f5d0cc77
RS
1495+++
1496** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
1497Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
eca7b908 1498`diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
f5d0cc77
RS
1499which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
1500how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
1501single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
1502day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
1503face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
1504appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
1505
33d0b73f
GM
1506+++
1507** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
1508year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
1509count backward from the end of the year.
1510
554b59cd
GM
1511+++
1512** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
1513prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
1514day of that ISO week.
1515
988c3fe3 1516---
97f3be50 1517** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
94f1c41a
GM
1518optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
1519rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
1520`christian-holidays' simpler.
97f3be50 1521
b9e6b498
GM
1522** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
1523This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
1524and `diary-header-line-format'.
1525
0fbe422d
GM
1526+++
1527** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
1528the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
1529`appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
1530appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
1531
d71d20ea
GM
1532** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
1533and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
1534from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
1535`diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
1536formats.
1537
1538
3f270c8a
AS
1539** VC Changes
1540
fc08c987
AS
1541*** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
1542the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
1543change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
1544with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
1545can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
1546
1547 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
1548
1549The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
1550
1c6576ab 1551+++
3f270c8a
AS
1552*** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
1553you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
1554by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
1555means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
1556allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
1557CVS.
1558
c64a682c
SM
1559*** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
1560
eb766f96
MK
1561** EDiff changes.
1562
16757dcf 1563+++
eb766f96
MK
1564*** When comparing directories.
1565Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
1566directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
1567from one directory to another.
1568
16757dcf 1569+++
eb766f96
MK
1570*** When comparing files or buffers.
1571Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
1572currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
1573then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
1574comparison.
1575
5d9c22fd 1576*** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
813f3d41
RS
1577backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
1578`ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
1579
ca8f3642 1580+++
e94a3679
FP
1581** Etags changes.
1582
73639417
FP
1583*** New regular expressions features
1584
1585**** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
df3eebcb
FP
1586The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
1587only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
1588--regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
1589where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
1590more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
6861f0e3
FP
1591(single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
1592expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
1593(which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
1594span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
1595and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
1596
2c37653c 1597**** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
6861f0e3
FP
1598The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
1599respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
1600CR, TAB, VT,
1601
2c37653c 1602**** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
df3eebcb
FP
1603The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
1604only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
1605particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
1606
2c37653c 1607**** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
df3eebcb
FP
1608The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
1609per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
1610
73639417
FP
1611*** New language parsing features
1612
d9256ccb
FP
1613**** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
1614Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
1615
5dc59f2e
FP
1616**** The gnucc __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
1617
dfcb9727
FP
1618**** New language HTML.
1619Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
1620used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
1621
1622**** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
1623If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
1624size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
1625
5dc59f2e
FP
1626**** New language Lua.
1627All functions are tagged.
dfcb9727 1628
73639417 1629**** In Perl, packages are tags.
81d66c62
FP
1630Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
1631as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
1632package::sub.
1633
dfcb9727
FP
1634**** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
1635
2c37653c
FP
1636**** New language PHP.
1637Tags are functions, classes and defines.
5dc59f2e 1638If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are variables also.
f175bfff 1639
73639417 1640**** New default keywords for TeX.
a0bbc0c5
FP
1641The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
1642renewenvironment.
1643
81d66c62
FP
1644*** Honour #line directives.
1645When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
1646directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
1647specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
1648created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
1649writes tags pointing to the source file.
bf8dd4e3 1650
2c37653c 1651*** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
a0bbc0c5 1652This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
5cc4f104 1653be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
dfcb9727 1654reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
a0bbc0c5 1655the file FILE.
06ee6fcd 1656
c30567b7 1657+++
b5a67081
MS
1658** CC Mode changes.
1659
1660*** Font lock support.
1661CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1662supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1663package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1664locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1665AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1666different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1667
1668The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1669dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1670strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1671declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1672lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1673the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1674demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1675therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1676variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1677
1678Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1679fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1680with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1681(e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1682mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1683take the better part of a minute.
1684
1685**** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1686are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1687be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1688locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1689properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1690not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1691
1692**** Support for documentation comments.
1693There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1694Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1695language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1696buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1697
1698Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1699and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1700list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1701is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1702
1703**** Better handling of C++ templates.
1704As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1705now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1706given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1707parens.
1708
1709This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1710work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1711template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1712recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1713not as configurable as it ought to be.
1714
1715**** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1716Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1717The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1718All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1719handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1720
1721*** Support for the AWK language.
1722Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1723based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1724any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1725Here is a summary:
1726
1727**** Indentation Engine
1728The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1729
1730AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1731which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1732placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1733are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1734definition, or structured statement.
1735
1736The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1737mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1738any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1739
1740The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1741though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1742fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1743C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1744
1745**** Font Locking
1746There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1747three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1748idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1749the AWK language itself.
1750
1751**** Comment Commands
1752M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1753comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1754
1755**** Movement Commands
1756Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1757exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1758(c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1759
1760The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1761pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1762recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1763functions.
1764
1765**** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1766Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1767the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1768invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1769
1770*** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1771The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1772now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1773module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1774composition-close, and incomposition.
1775
1776*** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1777The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
1778bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1779Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1780
1781*** Better control over require-final-newline.
1782The variable that controls how to handle a final newline when the
1783buffer is saved, require-final-newline, is now customizable on a
1784per-mode basis through c-require-final-newline. The default is to set
1785it to t only in languages that mandate a final newline in source files
1786(C, C++ and Objective-C).
1787
94b562dc
MS
1788*** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1789The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
1790and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
1791attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
1792cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
1793
1794((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
1795
1796is now analysed as
1797
1798((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
1799
1800In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
1801symbol.
1802
1803This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
1804and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
1805the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
1806with nil or an integer in the cdr.
b5a67081
MS
1807
1808*** API changes for derived modes.
1809There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
1810derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
1811incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
1812care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
1813Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
1814
1815**** New language variable system.
1816See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
1817
1818**** New initialization functions.
1819The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
1820give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
1821c-init-language-vars.
1822
1823*** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
1824The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
1825several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
1826now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
1827
1828This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
1829although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
1830gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
1831where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
1832it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1833
1834**** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
1835This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
1836its substatement. E.g:
1837
1838 if (x)
1839 x_is_true:
1840 do_stuff();
1841
1842*** Better handling of multiline macros.
1843
1844**** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
1845The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
1846syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
1847variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
1848cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
1849inside #define's.
1850
1851**** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
1852Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
1853of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
1854is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
1855removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
1856much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
1857empty lines within the macro better.
1858
1859**** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
1860This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
1861c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
1862
1863**** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1864c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
1865variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
1866backslashes can be moved.
1867
1868**** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1869This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
1870affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
1871inserted in auto-newline mode.
1872
1873**** Line indentation works better inside macros.
1874Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
1875inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
1876line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
1877indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
1878backslash) in the macro.
1879
1880*** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
1881The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
1882the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
1883on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
1884and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
1885(something which was hardcoded earlier).
1886
1887*** New function c-context-open-line.
1888It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
1889
1890*** New lineup functions
1891
1892**** c-lineup-string-cont
1893This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
1894continues. E.g:
1895
1896result = prefix + "A message "
1897 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
1898
1899**** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
1900Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
1901
1902**** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
1903Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
1904the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
1905
1906**** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
1907Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
1908Ryde.
1909
1910**** c-lineup-argcont
1911Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
1912Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1913
1914*** Better caching of the syntactic context.
1915CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
1916of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
1917places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
1918improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
1919moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
1920
1921The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
1922opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
1923only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
1924file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
1925context.
1926
1927*** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
1928Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
1929"invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
1930happen when macros are involved.
1931
1932*** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
1933It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
1934whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
1935point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
1936Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
1937line is left untouched.
1938
1939*** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
1940The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
1941syntactic indentation.
1942
406f228c
PJ
1943** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
1944--no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
1945
1c6576ab 1946+++
7ea42709
RS
1947** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
1948C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
1949
1c6576ab 1950+++
3a426197 1951** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1c6576ab
RS
1952with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1953whose names begin with space are omitted.
c30567b7 1954
2b6bb1f2 1955+++
3a426197
RS
1956** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
1957filling can break lines. We provide two sample predicates,
1958fill-single-word-nobreak-p and fill-french-nobreak-p.
8e8223e2 1959
1c6576ab 1960+++
1d57ac82 1961** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
d1b2b8cc
RS
1962When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1963starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1d57ac82 1964
2b6bb1f2 1965+++
2881ae98
SM
1966** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
1967The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
54c0e682 1968When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
79014980 1969i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2881ae98 1970By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
54c0e682 1971from the file name or buffer contents.
79014980 1972
2b6bb1f2 1973+++
9252f7bc 1974** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
cb8d4d07 1975
2a1e884e 1976---
1c6576ab 1977** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
30de4b24 1978
1c6576ab
RS
1979---
1980** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
30de4b24 1981
2d588beb 1982+++
1c6576ab 1983** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2d588beb
GM
1984Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
1985Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
a68c5400 1986
1c6576ab
RS
1987---
1988** F90 mode has new navigation commands `f90-end-of-block',
0d9e03be 1989`f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block', `f90-previous-block'.
e47b1d49 1990
2c375837
GM
1991** F90 mode now has support for hs-minor-mode (hideshow).
1992It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
1993majority.
1994
f607ff4b
GM
1995---
1996** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
1997the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
1998
1c6576ab
RS
1999---
2000** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2629d743
TTN
2001to support use of font-lock.
2002
1c6576ab 2003+++
026f408d
SM
2004** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
2005understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
2006`same-window'.
2007
1c6576ab 2008+++
6c0b2643
GM
2009** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
2010`${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
2011include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
2012
30743573 2013+++
58a11372
EZ
2014** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
2015If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
2016slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
2017completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
2018which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
2019candidate is a directory.
2020
1c6576ab 2021+++
af7272b1
RS
2022** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
2023to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
1c6576ab
RS
2024it remains unchanged.
2025
6a4940b2
MY
2026** Enhanced visual feedback in *Completions* buffer.
2027
2028Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
2029have in common and where they begin to differ.
2030
2031The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
2032`completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
2033same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
2034`completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
2035`completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
2036`completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
2037parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
2038parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
8bdbf30d 2039
2a1e884e 2040+++
6c0b2643
GM
2041** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
2042When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
2043displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
2044
2a1e884e 2045---
6c0b2643
GM
2046** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2047
2a1e884e 2048---
d3d268d5
JR
2049** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2050This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2051the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
2052
2a1e884e 2053---
f58b2333
JR
2054** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2055See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
2056
2a1e884e 2057---
3b7db268
JR
2058** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2059PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2060depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2061to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2062http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2063zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
9fc2be4c 2064against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
a3dde781 2065
f85bf1bf
JR
2066---
2067** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2068WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
6c098dbe 2069as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
f85bf1bf
JR
2070Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2071sound support for those formats.
2072
6c098dbe
JR
2073---
2074** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2075The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2076
1c6576ab 2077---
01a7f683
JR
2078** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2079The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2080whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2081pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2082
d18c4f98
JR
2083---
2084** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
d1b2b8cc
RS
2085The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2086the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2087colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2088default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2089some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2090`list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2091you wish to use them in other faces.
d18c4f98 2092
2b6bb1f2 2093+++
98659da6
KG
2094** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
2095The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
2096and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
2097use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
2098Meta and Alt:
2099 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
2100 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
7aa518f3 2101
1ce8d8b1 2102+++
7aa518f3
AS
2103** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
2104
2105In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2106enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2107to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2108
2109 P: annotates the previous revision
2110 N: annotates the next revision
2111 J: annotates the revision at line
2112 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2113 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2114 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2115 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
d82baff9
KS
2116
2117+++
2118** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2119between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2120in the repository.
2121
5dc0a68b
JL
2122+++
2123** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2124anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2125"checkout", "update" or "commit". That means using cvs diff options
2126-rBASE -rHEAD.
2127
46937ad8 2128\f
4581649e 2129* New modes and packages in Emacs 21.4
8f8da2d0 2130
c7eb99ce
DP
2131** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
2132varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
2133var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
2134section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
2135.config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
2136recognized.
2137
3d3b45dc
SJ
2138** The new package password.el provide a password cache and expiring mechanism.
2139
a3ba1a6a
SJ
2140** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
2141The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
2142to increment the SOA serial.
2143
3fc3e0a6
JL
2144** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
2145source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
2146
a422e170
DP
2147** The library tree-widget.el provides a new widget to display a set
2148of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
2149well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
2150
723addae 2151** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
033ad8c6
SM
2152buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
2153
723addae
EZ
2154** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
2155and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
2156
1e88a355
SM
2157** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
2158
f8f853de
SM
2159** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
2160
5df034de
LK
2161+++
2162** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
2163shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
2164
a95cefd7 2165** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
556621f6 2166
8f8da2d0 2167---
cd3782b4
KS
2168** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2169
2170The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
2171package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
2172to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
2173a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
ffe5000a 2174
2b6bb1f2 2175---
cd3782b4
KS
2176** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2177
2178The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
2461722b
KS
2179cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
2180With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
2181keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
2182region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
2183cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
2184
2185In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
2186rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
2187using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
2188or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
2189
2190Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
2191fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
2192downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
2193rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
2194as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
2195M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
2196rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
2197
2198Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
2199prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
2200C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
2201
2202The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
2203register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
2204
2205Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
2206When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
2207automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
2208commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
2209
2210The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
2211kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
2212want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
2213`cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
2214
cd3782b4
KS
2215Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
2216versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
2217must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
2218loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
2219
4e5cdb4f 2220** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
7920598e
KS
2221the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
2222keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
2223+, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
2224package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
2225
2226By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
2227`keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
2228using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
2229the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
2230possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
2231the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
2232
2233The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
2234`Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
2235`Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
2236decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
2237`Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
2238for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
2239where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
63e489f5
KS
2240`Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
2241are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
2242or local keymaps.
2461722b 2243
d82baff9 2244+++
4e5cdb4f 2245** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
ffe5000a
KS
2246emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
2247
e1fa392b
KS
2248Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
2249F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
2250the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
ffe5000a
KS
2251which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
2252
cc801373
KS
2253There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
2254defined macros.
2255
2256The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
2257defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
2258C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
2259manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
2260C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
2261for more commands.
2262
2c37653c 2263The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
cc801373 2264the keyboard macro ring.
ffe5000a 2265
f1f83e21
KS
2266The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
2267before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
e1fa392b
KS
2268
2269In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
2270be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
2271this behaviour via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
2272kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
2273
f1f83e21 2274Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
d1b2b8cc 2275C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
f1f83e21
KS
2276at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
2277
675d000f
RS
2278---
2279** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2280to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2281bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2282C-c C-i b, and so on.
2283
cd3782b4
KS
2284** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2285
2286If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
2287the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
2288with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
2289ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
2290printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
2291`ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
2292
66f520db 2293+++
4e5cdb4f 2294** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
66f520db
EZ
2295
2296Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
2297Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
52901be1
EZ
2298type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
2299available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
66f520db 2300
10088409 2301+++
4e5cdb4f 2302** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
c3d82b69
KG
2303
2304This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
2305files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
2306Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
2307for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
2308the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
2309`inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
2310connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
2311(which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
2312`rsync' to do the copying).
2313
2314Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
2315`su' and `sudo'.
2316
2a1e884e 2317---
4e5cdb4f 2318** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
49a42d13
MB
2319filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
2320that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
2321emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
2322invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
2323be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
4e3dd7cf 2324
2b6bb1f2 2325---
4e5cdb4f 2326** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
3c0fd84c
GM
2327"active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
2328change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
2329settings.
2330
2b6bb1f2 2331---
4e5cdb4f 2332** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
a95cefd7 2333move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
8a1f8073
SM
2334It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
2335of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
2336
2a1e884e 2337There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
adb6f9dc 2338
2a1e884e 2339---
4e5cdb4f 2340** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
81f755ae
CW
2341customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
2342
4e5cdb4f 2343** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
813f3d41
RS
2344`text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
2345these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
2346table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
2347can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
2348as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
2349
9cc1eb89 2350+++
4e5cdb4f
KS
2351** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
2352spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
2353letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
2354viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
2355
2a1e884e
RS
2356---
2357** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
4e3dd7cf
MB
2358Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
2359to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
2360mode-lines in inverse-video.
2361
9252f7bc 2362---
eb6055fa 2363** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
a8adf791 2364
500ae430
DL
2365** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
2366timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
2367
bcdf2143 2368** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the appearance of fringes.
46937ad8
DL
2369
2370** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
2371configuration files.
6c0b2643 2372\f
d278091b 2373* Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.4
851e5562 2374
1113094c 2375** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
d9c1ce9d
RS
2376arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
2377quit had occurred. while-no-input returns the value of BODY, if BODY
2378finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
2379
593b3517
RS
2380---
2381** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
2382proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
2383"files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
2384several versions ago.
2385
9d00469f
RS
2386+++
2387** read-from-minibuffer now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
2388saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
2389
dedbac89
RS
2390+++
2391** The new variable search-spaces-regexp controls how to search
2392for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
2393regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
2394expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
2395
2396Spaces inside of constructs such as [..] and *, +, ? are never
2397replaced with search-spaces-regexp.
2398
ee31cd78
RS
2399---
2400** list-buffers-noselect now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
2401If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
2402
2403---
2404** set-buffer-file-coding-system now takes an additional argument,
2405NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
2406
ae8bbb42 2407+++
18819b0f
RS
2408** The new function syntax-after returns the syntax code
2409of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
2410of text properties as well as the character code.
18819b0f 2411
66fcf39c
EZ
2412+++
2413** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
2414run time used by Emacs since start-up.
2415
2d1ef312
RS
2416+++
2417** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
6dd06769
LT
2418have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' did: it returns t if the
2419calling function was called through `call-interactively'. This should
2420only be used when you cannot add a new "interactive" argument to the
2421command.
2422
2423+++
2424** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
2425`assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
2426been declared obsolete.
2d1ef312 2427
c8636435
KS
2428+++
2429** An interactive specification may now use the code letter 'U' to get
2430the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
2431previous 'k' or 'K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
2432
d0ee2ed3
KH
2433** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
2434argument.
2435
143e9e6a 2436+++
7320911b 2437** Major mode functions now run the new normal hook
6622d928 2438`after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode hooks.
7320911b 2439
a020987f
LT
2440+++
2441** `auto-save-file-format' has been renamed to
2442`buffer-auto-save-file-format' and made into a permanent local.
2443
c90e7e43
LT
2444+++
2445** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
8392e138 2446been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
c90e7e43
LT
2447`disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
2448
0f7a93c1
KS
2449** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
2450width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
2451the usable window height and width is used.
2452
cbbfedb2
LT
2453+++
2454** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
2455a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
2456
2457** If a command sets transient-mark-mode to `only', that
02c04e6f
RS
2458enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
2459During that following command, the value of transient-mark-mode
2460is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
2461it changes to nil.
376de739 2462
092de21d
RS
2463+++
2464** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
2465
2466You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
2467same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
2468example,
2469
2470(kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
2471
0b0dea7b 2472** The sentinel is now called when a network process is deleted with
2e2d7ee6
KS
2473delete-process. The status message passed to the sentinel for a
2474deleted network process is "deleted". The message passed to the
2475sentinel when the connection is closed by the remote peer has been
2476changed to "connection broken by remote peer".
2477
08fd1251
RS
2478** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
2479undo-outer-limit, garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
2480it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
2481
092de21d 2482---
d6696bb6
KH
2483** New function quail-find-key returns a list of keys to type in the
2484current input method to input a character.
2485
092de21d
RS
2486+++
2487** New functions posn-at-point and posn-at-x-y return
b144fc11
RS
2488click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
2489position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
09fe18d3 2490
5b3dedcc
RS
2491** skip-chars-forward and skip-chars-backward now handle
2492character classes such as [:alpha:], along with individual characters
2493and ranges.
2494
b144fc11
RS
2495** Function pos-visible-in-window-p now returns the pixel coordinates
2496and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
2497arg is non-nil.
09fe18d3 2498
98a51048
JPW
2499** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
2500
08818866
EZ
2501+++
2502** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
2503modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
2504operation.
2505
ed2846bd 2506+++
c1cbc25a
KS
2507** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
2508supported on text terminals.
2509
ed2846bd 2510+++
09fe18d3
KS
2511** Support for displaying image slices
2512
2513*** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) may be used with
2514an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
2515
2516*** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
2517specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
2518
2519*** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
2520specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
2521
ed2846bd 2522+++
06859ebd 2523** New line-height and line-spacing properties for newline characters
e5847e56 2524
26fb226b
KS
2525A newline may now have line-height and line-spacing text or overlay
2526properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
e5847e56 2527
06859ebd
KS
2528If the line-height property value is 0, the newline does not
2529contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
6ab66799
KS
2530newline glyph is reduced. Also, a line-spacing property on this
2531newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
2532slices without adding blank areas between the images.
e5847e56 2533
06859ebd
KS
2534If the line-height property value is a positive integer, the value
2535specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
2536height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
e5847e56 2537
06859ebd 2538If the line-height property value is a float, the minimum line height
e71caa4e
KS
2539is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by the
2540given value.
06859ebd 2541
e71caa4e
KS
2542If the line-height property value is a cons (RATIO . FACE), the
2543minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
2544RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
06859ebd 2545
e71caa4e
KS
2546If the line-spacing property value is an positive integer, the value
2547is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
2548overrides the default frame line-spacing and any buffer local value of
2549the line-spacing variable.
06859ebd 2550
e71caa4e
KS
2551If the line-spacing property may be a float or cons, the line spacing
2552is calculated as specified above for the line-height property.
2553
6ab66799
KS
2554If the line-spacing value is a cons (total . SPACING) where SPACING is
2555any of the forms described above, the value of SPACING is used as the
2556total height of the line, i.e. a varying number of pixels are inserted
2557after each line to make each line exactly that many pixels high.
2558
e71caa4e
KS
2559** The buffer local line-spacing variable may now have a float value,
2560which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
09fe18d3 2561
ed2846bd 2562+++
c1cbc25a
KS
2563** Enhancements to stretch display properties
2564
2565The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
2566PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
e4aaf69c 2567specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
c1cbc25a
KS
2568
2569The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
2570which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
2571are supported:
2572
2573EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
2574NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
2575UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
2576ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
2577 | scroll-bar | text
2578POS ::= left | center | right
2579FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
2580OP ::= + | -
2581
2582The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
2583frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
2584pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
2585is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
2586pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
2587`height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
2588font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
2589the image.
2590
2591The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
2592`scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
e4aaf69c 2593corresponding area of the window.
c1cbc25a
KS
2594
2595The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
2596to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
2597of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
2598can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
2599relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
2600a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
2601these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
2602the width of the area.
2603
2604For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
2605 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
2606
2607If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
2608to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
2609header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
2610
2611The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
2612the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
2613width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
2614height) of the specified image.
2615
2616The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
2617The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
2618
ed2846bd 2619+++
4e14f66c
KS
2620** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
2621text property string that may be present at the current window
2622position. The cursor may now be placed on any character of such
2623strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
2624
982c8d45
SM
2625** New macro with-local-quit temporarily sets inhibit-quit to nil for use
2626around potentially blocking or long-running code in timers
2627and post-command-hooks.
2628
d9c1ce9d
RS
2629** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
2630`default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
2631defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and may be overridden
2632by them).
d3a403e5 2633
11a365f9
EZ
2634+++
2635** New face attribute `min-colors' can be used to tailor the face color
2636to the number of colors supported by a display, and define the
2637foreground and background colors accordingly so that they look best on
2638a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This is now the
2639preferred method for defining default faces in a way that makes a good
2640use of the capabilities of the display.
b19ac475 2641
ed2846bd
KS
2642+++
2643** Customizable fringe bitmaps
2644
f2a54fbc
KS
2645*** New function 'define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
2646fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
b2b681f1 2647
f2a54fbc
KS
2648To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
2649identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
b2b681f1 2650
ed2846bd 2651*** New function 'destroy-fringe-bitmap' may be used to destroy a
b2b681f1
KS
2652previously created bitmap, or restore a built-in bitmap.
2653
ed2846bd 2654*** New function 'set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
b2b681f1
KS
2655specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. Normally,
2656this should be a face derived from the `fringe' face, specifying
2657the foreground color as the desired color of the bitmap.
2658
ed2846bd 2659*** There are new display properties, left-fringe and right-fringe,
b2b681f1
KS
2660that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
2661bitmap of the display line.
2662
2663Format is 'display '(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE]), where BITMAP is a
f2a54fbc 2664symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
b2b681f1
KS
2665`define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
2666for displaying the bitmap.
2667
35ab4857
KS
2668*** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
2669bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
b2b681f1 2670
851e5562
KS
2671** Multiple overlay arrows can now be defined and managed via the new
2672variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'. It contains a list of
2673varibles which contain overlay arrow position markers, including
2674the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
2675
2676Each variable on this list may have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
2677and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
2678string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
2679systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
2680If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
2681'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
2682
4372d886
KS
2683+++
2684** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns line number of current
2685line in current buffer, or if optional buffer position is given, line
2686number of corresponding line in current buffer.
2687
9f4b6e73 2688+++
e91408d7
KH
2689** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
2690variable `sentence-end-without-space' which contains such characters
ac459e8a 2691that end a sentence without following spaces.
e91408d7 2692
9f4b6e73 2693+++
8bc51bd1
JL
2694** The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of
2695the variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil,
2696then this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
2697`sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
2698`sentence-end-without-space'.
2699
b19ac475
JY
2700+++
2701** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
2702`format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
2703implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
830047fd 2704
0610f22f
MB
2705** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
2706It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
2707One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
2708if no expansion is done, which may be tested using `eq'.
2709
9adcb5f2 2710+++
d0cd7210
LT
2711** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal' duplicates
2712from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element in the list,
43e48bda 2713the first one is kept.
d0cd7210 2714
3e7274ae
LT
2715+++
2716** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
2717documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
2718
652dd271
SJ
2719** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
2720before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
2721tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
2722sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
2723
e2b9b51f 2724+++
53092de4
EZ
2725** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
2726`yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
2727string. The old behavior is available if you call
2728`insert-for-yank-1' instead.
2729
d18473b9
LT
2730** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
2731arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
2732return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
2733whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
2734it was found as a text property or not found at all.
2735
ed2846bd
KS
2736+++ (lispref)
2737??? (man)
69348b2a
KS
2738** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
2739line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
2740controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
2741is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
2742(or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
2743
ed2846bd 2744+++
69348b2a
KS
2745** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
2746:pointer image property.
2747
ed2846bd 2748+++
69348b2a
KS
2749** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images may now be
2750controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
2751
ed2846bd 2752+++
69348b2a
KS
2753** Images may now have an associated image map via the :map property.
2754
2755An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
2756An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
2757A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
2758pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
2759A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
2760and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
2761A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
2762vector describes one corner in the polygon.
2763
2764When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
2765PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
2766property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
2767a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
2768it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
2769for possible pointer shapes.
2770
2771When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
2772an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
2773mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
2774
5f6eef94
KS
2775** Mouse event enhancements:
2776
2777*** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
2778events, rather than a text area click event.
2779
05faee07
KS
2780*** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
2781sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
2782corresponding text row.
2783
2784*** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
2785
5f6eef94
KS
2786+++
2787*** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
2788
2789+++
2790*** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
2791
5f6eef94 2792+++
3999c705 2793*** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
5f6eef94
KS
2794text area).
2795
2796+++
2797*** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
2798
2799+++
2800*** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
2801
d46aeafc
KS
2802+++
2803*** Mouse events may now include image object in addition to string object.
2804
2805+++
2806*** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
d18473b9 2807the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
d46aeafc 2808
05faee07
KS
2809+++
2810*** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
2811(image or character) clicked on.
2812
2813+++
2814*** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
2815'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
2816click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
2817of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
d46aeafc 2818
5f6eef94
KS
2819** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
2820one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
2821contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
2822changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
2823forcing an explicit window update.
2824
2825** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
2826debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
2827
76bf15e9
LT
2828+++
2829** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
2830the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
2831SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
2832nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
2833empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
2834
06a49fc1
LT
2835+++
2836** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
2837
c6177909
LT
2838+++
2839** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
2840new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
2841beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
2842documented.
2843
01b70437
DL
2844** Major modes can define `eldoc-print-current-symbol-info-function'
2845locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
2846the language.
2847
d18473b9 2848---
4a29bad2
DL
2849** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
2850the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
2851parts, e.g. utf-16.
2852
f6537e03 2853+++
0e7d7aae
RS
2854** The argument to forward-word, backward-word, forward-to-indentation
2855and backward-to-indentation is now optional, and defaults to 1.
2856
f6537e03
RS
2857+++
2858** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
2859to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
2860a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
2861
2862Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
2863does that, this value may not be accurate.
2864
51a8b435 2865+++
c6de56a0
RS
2866** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
2867actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
2868divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
2869the mode line.
2870
51a8b435 2871+++
c6de56a0
RS
2872** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
2873return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
2874
51a8b435 2875+++
bf078377
SM
2876** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
2877
51a8b435
RS
2878+++
2879** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
2880`switch-to-buffer'.
9c0fb8b9 2881
51a8b435
RS
2882+++
2883** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
2884selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
2885
2886+++
2887** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
2888text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
2889works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
9c0fb8b9 2890
51a8b435 2891+++
c64a682c
SM
2892** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
2893in the keymap.
2894
51a8b435 2895---
c64a682c
SM
2896** VC changes for backends:
2897*** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
2898*** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
2899parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
2900Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
2901uses the old `destfile' parameter.
2902
51a8b435 2903+++
c6de56a0
RS
2904** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
2905as a dynamic completion table.
2906
2907 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
2908
2909FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
2910and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
2911completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
2912can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
2913minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
2914entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
2915
51a8b435 2916+++
c6de56a0
RS
2917** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
2918as a lazy completion table.
2919
2920 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
2921
2922If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
2923as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
2924ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
2925completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
2926from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
2927`lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
2928
51a8b435 2929+++
5ceea398
RS
2930** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
2931
e50886d3
RS
2932+++
2933** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5ceea398
RS
2934for all (existing and future) frames.
2935
51a8b435 2936+++
5ceea398 2937** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
052797a7 2938
51a8b435 2939+++
052797a7
SM
2940** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
2941
51a8b435 2942+++
052797a7
SM
2943** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
2944
e50886d3 2945+++
211a9f6b
KH
2946** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
2947(or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
87a4ed45 2948'((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
211a9f6b
KH
2949point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
2950SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
2951
e50886d3 2952+++
eb67c5d6
RS
2953** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
2954numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
2955By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
2956as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
2957
e50886d3 2958+++
5d0ab731 2959** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
b0ada147
RS
2960specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
2961many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
2962`file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
2963
e50886d3 2964---
32d0a9dc
KH
2965** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
2966the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
2967
e50886d3 2968+++
63a08a73 2969** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
b23375aa
KS
2970unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
2971in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
2972In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
2973
e50886d3 2974+++
ce4254bd
KH
2975** New function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the multibyteness
2976of a string given to a process's filter.
2977
e50886d3 2978+++
ce4254bd
KH
2979** New function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if
2980a string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
2981
e50886d3 2982+++
ce4254bd
KH
2983** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string if
2984the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by the
2985value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
2986created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
2987
e50886d3 2988+++
ce4254bd
KH
2989** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
2990buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
2991to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
2992Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
2993which was not compatible with the behaviour of file reading.
2994
e50886d3 2995+++
b08d5f59
KH
2996** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
2997multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
2998
e50886d3 2999+++
6eed9bed
DL
3000** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
3001on garbage collection.
3002
e50886d3 3003+++
b08d5f59
KH
3004** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
3005it is read from a file without decoding.
b6c2aa59 3006
e50886d3
RS
3007+++
3008** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
175573ac 3009
e50886d3 3010+++
2155ecf3
RS
3011** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
3012of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
3013by calling `select-window'.
3014
e50886d3 3015---
2155ecf3
RS
3016** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
3017if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
3018into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
3019need to have a name.
3020
f08830d2
DL
3021** Byte compiler changes:
3022
e50886d3 3023---
f08830d2
DL
3024*** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
3025helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
3026Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
3027efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
3028generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
3029you anything.
3030
e50886d3 3031+++
f08830d2
DL
3032*** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
3033simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
3034useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
3035Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
3036forms:
3037
3038 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
3039 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
3040
3041In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
3042won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
3043second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
3044unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
3045macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
3046`unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
c60ee5e7 3047
e50886d3
RS
3048+++
3049*** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
3050inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
3051
3052+++
3053** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3054is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3055be inserted is translated through it.
a4ac5b17 3056
9252f7bc
RS
3057+++
3058** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
a4ac5b17 3059which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
9252f7bc
RS
3060current file redefined it).
3061
e50886d3 3062+++
d2d70cb6
JY
3063** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
3064whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
3065instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
3066testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
3067show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
3068a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
3069
3070*** Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely evaluated;
3071a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same value. The red
3072splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly complete their evaluation,
3073such as `error'. The brown splotches are skipped for forms that are expected
3074to always evaluate to the same value, such as (setq x 14).
3075
3076*** For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to help
9f8a930d
JY
3077out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a red splotch.
3078It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does return. The macro 1value
3079suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. This macro is a no-op except
3080during test-coverage -- then it signals an error if the argument actually
3081returns differing values.
d2d70cb6 3082
9cc1eb89 3083+++
d2d70cb6
JY
3084** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
3085do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
3086unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
3087
e50886d3
RS
3088+++
3089** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
3090that successive calls to print functions should use the same
3091numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
3092when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3093
3094When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3095also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3116d142 3096
e50886d3 3097+++
7c3cb37d
RS
3098** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
3099the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
3100
e50886d3 3101+++
7c3cb37d
RS
3102** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
3103is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3104
21beb82f 3105+++
add89676
RS
3106** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
3107It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
21beb82f 3108can start with this line:
add89676
RS
3109
3110 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
3111
3bd7a6ed
TTN
3112** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
3113Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
3114appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
3115
3116 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
3117
3118Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
3119in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
3120
e50886d3 3121+++
02ce3e80
SM
3122** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
3123its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
3124
e50886d3 3125---
fc2938d1
DL
3126** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
3127hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
3128
e50886d3 3129+++
3bcd2096
JPW
3130** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional buffer
3131argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted it defaults to
3132the current buffer.
79fab26b 3133
c5e0561f 3134+++
56592beb
RS
3135** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
3136and `display-warning'.
3137
e50886d3 3138+++
a7bd9dc7
SM
3139** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
3140of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3141and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3142exported to Lisp.
3143
e50886d3 3144---
1c6576ab
RS
3145** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
3146much pure storage it will approximately need.
3147
e50886d3 3148+++
2b6bb1f2
RS
3149** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
3150to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
3151for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
3152file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
3153
e50886d3 3154---
cc305a60
RS
3155** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
3156of one coding system from another coding system.
3157
661e85c1 3158+++
2b6bb1f2
RS
3159** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3160are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3161specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3162such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3163needed.
3164
c5e0561f 3165---
2b6bb1f2
RS
3166** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3167that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3168appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3169is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3170ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3171with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3172
3173If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3174confirmation as before.
3175
c5e0561f 3176+++
6f8968c8 3177** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
2b6bb1f2 3178
6f8968c8
KS
3179The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
3180can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
3181frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
3182Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
2b6bb1f2 3183
6f8968c8
KS
3184The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
3185specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
3186integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
3187between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
3188specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
3189only the left fringe gets the specified width).
2b6bb1f2
RS
3190
3191Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
3192width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
3193of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
3194fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
3195
c5e0561f 3196+++
6f8968c8
KS
3197** Per-window fringes settings
3198
3199Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and position
3200settings.
3201
3202To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
3203variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
3204`set-window-fringes'.
3205
3206To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
3207are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
3208or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
3209`fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
3210
3211The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
3212settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
3213`fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
3214displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
3215an update of the display margins.
3216
f6537e03 3217+++
6f8968c8
KS
3218** Per-window vertical scroll-bar settings
3219
3220Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
3221controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
3222
3223To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
3224variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
3225`set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
3226used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
3227`scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
3228the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
3229of the display margins.
3230
c5e0561f 3231+++
6f8968c8
KS
3232** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
3233KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
3234and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
3235
f2aa473a 3236+++
2d586478 3237** Renamed hooks to better follow the naming convention:
2881ae98
SM
3238find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
3239find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
3240write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
2d586478
SM
3241write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions,
3242x-lost-selection-hooks to x-lost-selection-functions,
3243x-sent-selection-hooks to x-sent-selection-functions.
2881ae98
SM
3244Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
3245
c5e0561f 3246+++
c60ee5e7 3247** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
7757cdaf
JPW
3248It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
3249name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
3250
c5e0561f 3251+++
02f20f98
KS
3252** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3253specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3254new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3255while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3256variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3257
c5e0561f 3258---
02f20f98
KS
3259** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
3260to override the internal read-file-name function.
3261
94966e2b
JPW
3262
3263** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3264whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3265`read-file-name' function.
3266
c5e0561f 3267+++
21b6d966
KS
3268** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
3269`read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
3270will only show directories.
3271
c5e0561f 3272+++
af7272b1
RS
3273** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3274non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3275its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
261b01c6 3276The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
af7272b1 3277
c5e0561f 3278---
af7272b1
RS
3279** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
3280now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
3281(require 'cl) when loaded.
3282
c5e0561f 3283+++
ee9e0c25
GM
3284** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
3285indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
3286syntax of defmacro has been extended to
3287
3288 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3289
3290DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3291declaration specifiers supported are:
3292
3293(indent INDENT)
3294 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3295
3296(edebug DEBUG)
3297 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3298 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
3299
0e7d7aae 3300+++
93607efd
KS
3301** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3302
3303This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
dfd67a62 3304to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
93607efd
KS
3305binding and lookup functionality.
3306
3307When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3308remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3309original command.
3310
3311Example:
3312Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
3313my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
3314bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
3315kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
3316kill-word.
3317
3318Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3319command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
3320my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
3321map using define-key:
3322
a8959ac2
KS
3323 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3324 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
93607efd
KS
3325
3326Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
3327the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
3328
3329Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
3330example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
3331then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
3332
3333The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3334
a8959ac2
KS
3335- Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3336 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3337 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3338 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
93607efd 3339
a84db054
KS
3340- The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3341 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
93607efd
KS
3342
3343- key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
a8959ac2 3344 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
93607efd
KS
3345
3346- where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3347 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3348 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3349 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3350 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
3351 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
3352
3353- The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3354 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3355 command was not remapped.
3356
0e7d7aae 3357+++
3f21fb3a
KS
3358** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
3359
3360Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3361keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
3362alist to this list.
3363
f6537e03 3364+++
108eaabb
RS
3365** Atomic change groups.
3366
3367To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3368they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3369around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3370
3371 (atomic-change-group
3372 (insert foo)
3373 (delete-region x y))
3374
3375If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3376`atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3377were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3378on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3379
3380If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3381lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3382
3383To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3384Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3385This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3386the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3387
3388Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3389group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3390do this.
3391
3392After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3393either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3394`accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3395call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3396
3397You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3398finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3399`unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3400(This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3401`activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3402group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3403twice.
3404
3405To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3406for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3407returned values, like this:
3408
3409 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3410 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3411
3412You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3413to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3414`accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3415
3416Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3417would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3418will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3419change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3420finished.
3421
f17c0a19
CW
3422+++
3423** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
3424
3425This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
3426properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
3427although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
3428to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
3429
0e7d7aae 3430+++
f17c0a19
CW
3431** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
3432
3433This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
3434M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
3435property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
3436new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
3437
0e7d7aae 3438+++
d9f7eb77
RS
3439** New function remove-list-of-text-properties.
3440
3441The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties' is almost the same
3442as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes
3443a list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
3444
0e7d7aae 3445+++
18232c16 3446** New function insert-for-yank.
d278091b 3447
18232c16
KS
3448This function normally works like `insert' but removes the text
3449properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list. However, if the
3450inserted text has a `yank-handler' text property on the first
3451character of the string, the insertion of the text may be modified in
3452a number of ways. See the description of `yank-handler' below.
3453
0e7d7aae 3454+++
18232c16
KS
3455** New function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank.
3456
3457This function works like `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the
3458text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
d278091b 3459
0e7d7aae 3460+++
d278091b
KS
3461** New function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
3462
18232c16
KS
3463This function is like insert-buffer-substring, but removes all
3464text properties from the inserted substring.
3465
0e7d7aae 3466+++
18232c16
KS
3467** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
3468previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
3469
0e7d7aae 3470The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
18232c16 3471elements with the following format:
a6098104 3472 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
18232c16
KS
3473
3474The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3475the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3476element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
3477the normal behaviour of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3478
3479 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3480to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3481 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3482passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3483`yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3484rectangle.
3485 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3486yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3487responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3488if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3489 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3490by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
c60ee5e7 3491called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
18232c16 3492FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
18232c16 3493
0e7d7aae
RS
3494*** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
3495optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
3496the killed text.
18232c16
KS
3497
3498*** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3499`yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
3500yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
3501insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3502element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
3503
f6537e03 3504+++
11ef2a3b
MB
3505** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
3506whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
3507
3508A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
3509specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
3510defined with defface.
3511
7e07a66d
MB
3512** The function face-differs-from-default-p now truly checks whether the
3513given face displays differently from the default face or not (previously
3514it did only a very cursory check).
3515
f6537e03 3516+++
3d619ea1
MB
3517** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
3518accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
3519inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
3520
f6537e03 3521+++
3d619ea1
MB
3522** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
3523help with handling relative face attributes.
3524
a0a23346
MB
3525** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face-list is reversed.
3526If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
3527faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous releases
3528of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made so that
3529:inherit face-lists operate identically to face-lists in text `face'
3530properties.
3531
f6537e03 3532+++
15aeeda5
KS
3533** Enhancements to process support
3534
3535*** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3536only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
3537
3538*** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
3539functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
3540supported, but new code should use the new functions.
3541
3542*** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
3543name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3544
e519464c 3545*** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
c60ee5e7 3546maintain process state and other per-process related information.
e519464c
KS
3547
3548The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
3549and modify elements on this property list.
3550
3551The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
3552used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
3553
101c421e
KS
3554*** Function accept-process-output now has an optional fourth arg
3555`just-this-one'. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3556is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3557integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3558recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3559speech synthesis.
3560
31e0fbdd
KS
3561*** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
3562
3563On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3564output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
3565very poor performance. This behaviour can be remedied to some extent
3566by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
3567non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3568from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3569emacs tries to read it.
3570
f6537e03 3571+++
fd13a3cc 3572** Enhanced networking support.
1e892206 3573
fd13a3cc
KS
3574*** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
3575opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3576create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
1e892206 3577
fd13a3cc 3578- A server is started using :server t arg.
60a501d7 3579- Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
fd13a3cc
KS
3580- A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3581- Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3582- Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
e519464c
KS
3583- The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
3584 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3585 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
1e892206 3586
60a501d7
KS
3587To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3588 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
3589
fd13a3cc
KS
3590*** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
3591
3592*** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
3593
3594This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
8e9e520b
KS
3595without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3596filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3597connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3598matching "open" or "failed".
fd13a3cc
KS
3599
3600*** New function open-network-stream-server.
8e9e520b
KS
3601
3602This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3603When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3604is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3605is called for the new process.
fd13a3cc
KS
3606
3607*** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
8e9e520b
KS
3608
3609These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3610and set the current address of the remote partner.
fd13a3cc 3611
4e5cdb4f 3612*** New function format-network-address.
8e9e520b
KS
3613
3614This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
3615to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3616number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3617printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3618string for other formatting options.
4e5cdb4f 3619
fd13a3cc
KS
3620*** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
3621for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
3622of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
3623
3624Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
3625remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
3626element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
3627the fifth is the port number.
3628
3629*** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
3630`stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
3631connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
3632no input is received in the stopped state.
3633
205f1dde
KS
3634*** New function network-interface-list.
3635
3636This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3637current network addresses.
3638
0c4da023 3639*** New function network-interface-info.
205f1dde
KS
3640
3641This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3642status, and other information about a specific network interface.
3643
f6537e03 3644+++
6ba3d6bc
CW
3645** New function copy-tree.
3646
f6537e03 3647+++
9ade4a7d
RS
3648** New function substring-no-properties.
3649
f6537e03 3650+++
3bdb7f80
KS
3651** New function minibuffer-selected-window.
3652
f6537e03 3653+++
4e3dd7cf
MB
3654** New function `call-process-shell-command'.
3655
213856ba
KG
3656** New function `process-file'.
3657
3658This is similar to `call-process', but obeys file handlers. The file
3659handler is chosen based on default-directory.
3660
f6537e03 3661---
f6078b98
RS
3662** The dummy function keys made by easymenu
3663are now always lower case. If you specify the
3664menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
3665as the "key" bound by that key binding.
3666
3667This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for
3668the bindings that were made with easymenu.
3669
0e7d7aae 3670+++
f6078b98
RS
3671** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
3672argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
3673for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
3674and does not return t for keyboard macros.
3675
f6537e03 3676---
2a1e884e
RS
3677** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
3678buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
3679
3680It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
3681and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
3682buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
3683commands.
3684
3685This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
3686sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
3687SQL buffer.
3688
3689(add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
3690 (function (lambda ()
3691 (master-mode t)
3692 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
3693(add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
3694 (function (lambda ()
3695 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
3696
f6537e03 3697+++
596d02bc
RS
3698** File local variables.
3699
3700A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3701properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3702
d33c4505
RS
3703+++
3704** New function window-body-height.
3705
3706This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
3707or the header line.
3708
0e7d7aae 3709+++
21b6d966
KS
3710** New function format-mode-line.
3711
3712This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
f4d7915c 3713specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
21b6d966 3714
9f89426b
KS
3715+++
3716** New function safe-plist-get.
3717
3718This function is like plist-get, but never signals an error for
3719a malformed property list.
3720
0e7d7aae 3721+++
9356fe5a
RS
3722** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3723
3724These functions are like `plist-get' and `plist-put' except that they
3725compare the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3726
0e7d7aae 3727+++
4f4fada2
RS
3728** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
3729
9252f7bc 3730The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
4f4fada2
RS
3731recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
3732Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
3733you specify the map to use as an argument.
3734
c4f59bcf
EZ
3735+++
3736** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3737
3738When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3739angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3740equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3741
75e20bec
RS
3742+++
3743** You can now make a window as short as one line.
3744
3745A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
3746line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
3747`header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
3748cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
3749variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
3750
e0c124ce
EZ
3751+++
3752** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
3753for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
3754number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
3755Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
3756
bc3b02f9
LK
3757+++
3758** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
3759used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
3760
86b9b767
LK
3761+++
3762** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3763:propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3764`risky-local-variable' property is nil.
596d02bc 3765
5df034de
LK
3766+++
3767** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
3768to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
3769line.
3770
1c6576ab
RS
3771---
3772** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
3773cl-indent package. The new user options
3774`lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
3775`lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
3776indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
3777
3778---
3779** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
3780cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3781
1ae7cf5e 3782+++
aaddfb29
RS
3783** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
3784
3785Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
3786from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
3787buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
3788now:
3789
37901. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
3791
37922. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
3793the time it takes to convert the format.
3794
37953. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
3796wasteful.
3797
1ae7cf5e 3798+++
edde72f6
RS
3799** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3800over minor mode keymaps.
3801
1ae7cf5e 3802+++
0065bb74
RS
3803** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
3804An octal escape makes it unibyte.
3805
1ae7cf5e 3806+++
5ceea398
RS
3807** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
3808text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
3809image or composition property.
3810
c64a682c
SM
3811This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
3812This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
3813unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
3814(including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
3815post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
5d0ab731 3816
51a8b435 3817+++
bf36a6d3
MB
3818** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
3819argument, LIMIT.
4e02881b 3820
ef8aee62 3821+++
1b8c66fe
RS
3822** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
3823non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
3824it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
3825Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
3826flag.
3827
51a8b435 3828---
c95eaa61
PJ
3829** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3830
51a8b435 3831---
c95eaa61
PJ
3832** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
3833
51a8b435 3834---
111ed14e
SM
3835** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
3836Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
3837find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
3838that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
3839handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
3840In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3841
51a8b435 3842---
cfaa4a1b 3843** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
59b59892
SM
3844Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3845bindings of the parent keymap.
cfaa4a1b 3846
51a8b435 3847---
f67cc62e
SM
3848** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
3849If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
3850(see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
3851be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
3852depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
3853is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
3854
3855 s{
3856 foo
3857 }{
3858 bar
3859 }e
3860
3861Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
3862text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
3863property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
3864refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
3865
51a8b435 3866---
6710ea06 3867** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
fbe51115 3868called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
6710ea06 3869
16927a56 3870** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
d18473b9 3871(the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
16927a56 3872
51a8b435 3873+++
16927a56
SM
3874** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
3875it receives a request from emacsclient.
3876
51a8b435 3877---
8727d588
RS
3878** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
3879Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
3880than 3 levels of nesting.
3881
51a8b435 3882---
1c1d3d69
RS
3883** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
3884property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
3885it in that buffer.
3886
51a8b435 3887---
ae4000f1 3888** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
1ff74324 3889properties from surrounding text.
1c1d3d69 3890
bcdf2143 3891+++
d1b2b8cc
RS
3892** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3893element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3894accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
bcdf2143 3895
51a8b435 3896+++
830047fd
RS
3897** New function `buffer-local-value'.
3898
830047fd
RS
3899This function returns the buffer-local binding of VARIABLE (a symbol)
3900in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not have a buffer-local binding in
3901buffer BUFFER, it returns the default value of VARIABLE instead.
6c0b2643 3902
51a8b435 3903---
8e8223e2
SM
3904** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3905that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3906clone to the other.
3907
51a8b435 3908+++
8e8223e2
SM
3909** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
3910*** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
d390f4aa 3911of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
8e8223e2
SM
3912other properties than `face'.
3913*** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
3914properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
3915
51a8b435 3916---
0df7a0b6
EZ
3917** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
3918or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
51a8b435
RS
3919`defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
3920the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
3921directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
0df7a0b6 3922
51a8b435 3923+++
8e8223e2
SM
3924** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
3925are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
3926parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
3927
51a8b435 3928+++
0ec6b206
SM
3929** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
3930and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
3931
51a8b435 3932+++
7c3cb37d
RS
3933** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
3934It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
3935
a7bd9dc7 3936+++
8e8223e2
SM
3937** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
3938to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
7bea57c9 3939and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
8e8223e2 3940
202082d3
EZ
3941+++
3942** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3943ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3944`.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3945
51a8b435 3946+++
63ca0a6e
GM
3947** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
3948user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
3949accepts a float as UID parameter.
3950
51a8b435 3951---
30de4b24
SM
3952** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3953
51a8b435 3954+++
30de4b24
SM
3955** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
3956
51a8b435 3957+++
1c6576ab
RS
3958** The Emacs Lisp byte-compiler now displays the actual line and
3959character position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form
3960of its warning and error messages have been brought more in line with
3961the output of other GNU tools.
3962
51a8b435 3963+++
026f408d
SM
3964** New functions `keymap-prompt' and `current-active-maps'.
3965
51a8b435 3966---
026f408d
SM
3967** New function `describe-buffer-bindings'.
3968
51a8b435 3969+++
026f408d
SM
3970** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3971searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
3972
51a8b435 3973+++
cb8d4d07 3974** Variable aliases have been implemented:
6c0b2643 3975
51a8b435 3976*** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
6c0b2643 3977
3fdb4c50
JB
3978This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3979symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3980returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3981changes the value of BASE-VAR.
6c0b2643 3982
32ebbc3a
JB
3983DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3984the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3985
51a8b435 3986*** indirect-variable VARIABLE
6c0b2643
GM
3987
3988This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3989of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3990defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3991
3992It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3993variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3994
51a8b435 3995+++
6c0b2643
GM
3996** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
3997collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
3998
51a8b435 3999+++
ace64e0a
GM
4000** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
4001the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
4002
51a8b435 4003+++
123ac55e 4004** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
51a8b435 4005hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
123ac55e 4006
51a8b435 4007---
0b559506
JR
4008** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4009The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4010formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4011
51a8b435
RS
4012** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
4013display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
6b3daede
GM
4014using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4015
c94472fc
JD
4016** New function x-send-client-message sends a client message when
4017running under X.
4018
f24485f1 4019** Arguments for remove-overlays are now optional, so that you can remove
e71caa4e 4020all overlays in the buffer by just calling (remove-overlay).
f24485f1 4021
30de4b24
SM
4022** New packages:
4023
71c88486
NR
4024*** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
4025GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
4026there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
4027state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
f2afecda
NR
4028that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
4029Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
71c88486
NR
4030
4031Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
4032
30de4b24
SM
4033*** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
4034current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
4035
ffe5000a
KS
4036*** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
4037binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
4038data structures.
4039
e95768c5 4040*** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
c494f663
CW
4041This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
4042
4e3dd7cf
MB
4043*** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
4044in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
4045implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
4046require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
4047as help and apropos buffers.
4048
6c0b2643 4049\f
71c88486
NR
4050* Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4051
4052** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4053been added.
4054
4055\f
4056* Changes in Emacs 21.3
4057
4058** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4059with Custom.
4060
4061** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
2d2ff530 4062as mule-utf-8.
71c88486
NR
4063
4064** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4065in UTF-8 locales).
4066
4067** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4068different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4069Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4070and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4071between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4072(e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4073`unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4074`unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4075it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4076By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4077
4078** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4079`selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4080
4081If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4082compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4083compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4084text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behaviour is actually
4085contrary to the compound text specification.
4086
4087\f
4088* Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4089
4090** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4091
4092** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4093
4094\f
4095* Changes in Emacs 21.2
4096
4097** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4098
4099X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4100compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4101list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4102selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4103compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4104
4105** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4106were changed.
4107
4108** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4109now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4110
4111** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4112initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4113instead of using default-major-mode.
4114
4115** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4116like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
4117as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
4118(the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
4119visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
4120is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
4121to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
4122
4123This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
4124NEWS.
4125
4126\f
4127* Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
4128
4129** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
4130have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
4131and the latter now controls scrolling down.
4132
4133** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
4134be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
4135
4136\f
251584f3
DL
4137* Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
4138
889be0a1
DL
4139See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
4140fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
4141charsets in this release.
4142
f4988be7
GM
4143** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
4144
424d8b44
DL
4145** Support for LynxOS has been added.
4146
1fa28578 4147** There are new configure options associated with the support for
163ea954
RS
4148images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
4149to list them.
6344985d 4150
5ed8d5af 4151** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
60dd7e0e 4152support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
8628686a
DL
4153maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
4154build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
4155necessary changes to unexec.
f4988be7 4156
efeb796b
EZ
4157** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
4158Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
4159
4160** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
4161Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
4162
4163** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
4164the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
d9c9b920 4165
e90813b8 4166** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
a7c13351 4167all of the new display features described below. The port currently
d69aa2e3
EZ
4168lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
4169"Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
4170description of aspects specific to the Mac.
d9c9b920 4171
efeb796b
EZ
4172** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
4173new display features described below.
4174
05197f40 4175\f
1fa28578
GM
4176* Changes in Emacs 21.1
4177
1e7db2e9
GM
4178** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
4179
4180The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
4181Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
4182oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
4183of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
4184the text.
4185
4186** Emacs has a new face implementation.
4187
4188The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
4189font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
4190height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
4191These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
4192specify a font.
4193
4194Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
4195These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
4196under Lisp changes, below.
4197
4198** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
4199
4200Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
4201Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
4202the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
4203italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
4204Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
4205attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
4206on terminals.
4207
4208The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
4209supported on character terminals.
4210
efeb796b
EZ
4211Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
4212the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
4213same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
4214a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
4215
1e7db2e9
GM
4216** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
4217
efeb796b
EZ
4218** Sound support
4219
4220Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
4221driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
4222supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
c8682017
EZ
4223You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
4224sound support.
efeb796b 4225
1e7db2e9
GM
4226** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
4227
4228If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
4229longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
4230is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
4231minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
4232
4233- User option: max-mini-window-height
4234
4235Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
4236fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
4237specifies a number of lines.
4238
4239Default is 0.25.
4240
4241- User option: resize-mini-windows
4242
4243How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
4244resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
4245grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
4246again.
4247
4248Default is `grow-only'.
4249
4250** LessTif support.
4251
4252Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
a04c6760 4253<http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
1e7db2e9
GM
4254
4255** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
4256
4257When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
4258from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
4259non-nil.
4260
8f80abd8
EZ
4261** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
4262
4263When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
4264now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
4265file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
4266
1e7db2e9
GM
4267** Toolkit scroll bars.
4268
4269Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
4270LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
4271configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
4272bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
4273bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
4274Emacs.
4275
4276When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
4277Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
4278Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
4279Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
4280define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
4281`s/freebsd.h' as an example.
4282
4283Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
4284a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
4285directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
4286different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
4287system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
4288add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
4289
4290The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
4291`float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
4292This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
3593c177 4293imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
1e7db2e9
GM
4294Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
4295
1e7db2e9
GM
4296** Tool bar support.
4297
4298Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
4299of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
4300changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
4301displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
4302if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
4303icons will be used.
4304
4305To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
70fae708 4306for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
1e7db2e9 4307
1e7db2e9
GM
4308** Tooltips.
4309
4310Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
4311mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
4312turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
4313
4314Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
4315variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
4316the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
4317tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
4318
efeb796b
EZ
4319** Automatic Hscrolling
4320
4321Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
4322`automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
4323customized.
4324
4325If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
4326scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
4327for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
4328the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
4329to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
4330
1e7db2e9
GM
4331** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
4332of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
4333solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
ab9c49cf 4334`cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
1e7db2e9 4335cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
2018166d 4336non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
1e7db2e9
GM
4337
4338** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
4339truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
4340foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
4341customizing face `fringe'.
4342
4343** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
4344You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
4345In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
4346appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
4347occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
4348the window to be partially obscured.)
4349
4350The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
46ff99c0
MB
4351versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
4352However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
4353ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
1e7db2e9 4354
1e7db2e9
GM
4355** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
4356
6b9572dc
EZ
4357Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
4358systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
4359mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
4360mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
4361displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
4362have enabled one.
1e7db2e9
GM
4363
4364Currently, the following actions have been defined:
4365
3aa2f38a 4366- Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
1e7db2e9 4367
3aa2f38a 4368- Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
1e7db2e9
GM
4369
4370- Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
4371`*') toggles the status.
4372
4373- Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
4374
1e7db2e9
GM
4375** Hourglass pointer
4376
4377Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
4378turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
4379
1e7db2e9
GM
4380** Blinking cursor
4381
4382M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
4383terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
4384and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
4385the group `cursor'.
4386
1e7db2e9
GM
4387** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
4388
4389This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
4390generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
4391See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
4392details.
4393
4394Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
4395have to do anything to activate it.
4396
efeb796b
EZ
4397** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
4398
4399The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
4400determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
4401
4402On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
4403according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
4404key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
4405option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
4406delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
4407keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
4408keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
4409set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
4410
4411If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
4412a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
4413Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
4414`keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
4415the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
4416terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
4417
4418Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
4419to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
4420
1e7db2e9
GM
4421** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
4422changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
4423buffer by default.
4424
4425** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
4426current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
4427beginning and end of the buffer.
4428
4429** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
4430recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
4431signaled.
4432
4433** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
4434file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
4435
1e7db2e9
GM
4436** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
4437compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
4438this behavior.
4439
efeb796b 4440The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
1e7db2e9
GM
4441compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
4442Emacs dump core.
4443
4444** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
4445
4446When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
4447widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
4448Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
4449
4450** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
4451more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
4452now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
4453
4454** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
4455using that menu.
4456
1e7db2e9
GM
4457** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
4458
4459When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
4460whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
4461defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
4462highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
4463displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
4464whitespace.
4465
1e7db2e9
GM
4466** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
4467all frames except the selected one.
4468
4469** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
4470let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
4471
1e7db2e9
GM
4472** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
4473header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
4474so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
4475This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
4476`Info-use-header-line'.
4477
1e7db2e9
GM
4478** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
4479have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
4480`de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
4481
4482** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
4483
4484** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
4485`dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
4486`fr-drdref.tex'.
4487
1e7db2e9
GM
4488** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
4489displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
4490menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
4491menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
4492
efeb796b 4493** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
17851d9d 4494
a19e85cc 4495You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
17851d9d
EZ
4496because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
4497use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
4498`~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
1e7db2e9 4499
1e7db2e9
GM
4500** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
4501point in a pop-up window.
4502
1e7db2e9
GM
4503** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
4504under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
4505customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
4506
4507The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
4508determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
4509
1e7db2e9
GM
4510** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
4511sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
4512(On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
aa082854 4513You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
1e7db2e9 4514
1e7db2e9
GM
4515** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
4516
eb1b0c74
GM
4517** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
4518to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
4519
c607d53d 4520** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
346598f1 4521trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
c607d53d
SS
4522this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
4523
4104194e 4524** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
1e36ff68
DL
4525be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
4526non-nil.
4104194e 4527
ba9eeda1
GM
4528** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
4529set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
4530file that is already visited under a different name.
4531
42ac0ae5
GM
4532** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
4533nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
4534
ba9eeda1 4535** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
eb27839a 4536and displays information about that.
b941a14b 4537
25ad1371
GM
4538** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
4539expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
4540
4541This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
4542determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
4543mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
4544interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
4545regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
4546associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
4547
40e857ea 4548** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
424d8b44 4549suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
40e857ea 4550
c08398de
DL
4551** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
4552buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
4553contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
4554by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
4555insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
4556the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
4557Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
4558
efeb796b
EZ
4559** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
4560been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
4561
efeb796b
EZ
4562** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
4563system for keyboard input.
4564
3d6cd763
GM
4565** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
4566coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
4567escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
4568such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
4569recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
07b14857 4570always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
3d6cd763 4571read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
07b14857
KH
4572(`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
4573RET C-x C-f filename RET.
26ae8525 4574
0b8a3a6d
DL
4575** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
4576environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
4577
0b8a3a6d
DL
4578** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
4579displays all characters in that character set.
4580
4581** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
4582coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
4583
efeb796b
EZ
4584** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
4585and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
4586LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
4587
efeb796b
EZ
4588** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
4589Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
45908859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
4591GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
45928859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
4593There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
4594and Polish `slash'.
4595
efeb796b
EZ
4596** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
4597These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
4598of the tutorial.
4599
4600** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
4601function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
4602Lisp Coding Convention".
4603
4604 new command old-binding
4605 --- ------- -----------
4606 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
4607 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
4608 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
4609
4610 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
4611 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
4612 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
4613
4614 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
4615 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
4616 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
4617 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
4618 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
4619 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
4620
bd161121
EZ
4621** There are new Leim input methods.
4622New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
4623"greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
4624package.
4625
efeb796b
EZ
4626** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
4627rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
4628typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
4629"=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
4630"`", you must type "=q".
4631
efeb796b
EZ
4632** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
46338859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
4634more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
4635empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
4636window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
4637on.
4638
efeb796b
EZ
4639** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
4640on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
4641defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
4642commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5cb6a58e 4643
5898e075
DL
4644** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
4645`display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
4646indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
4647indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
4648
cc181e95
GM
4649** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
4650on the display using several methods
4651
4652- By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
4653a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
4654be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
4655
4656- By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5820dead 4657equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
cc181e95 4658
da4496b6 4659- By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
cc181e95
GM
4660
4661- By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
4662the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
4663
3b4fa1b2 4664** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
1c459486 4665an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
3b4fa1b2 4666command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
1c459486 4667does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
0daee095 4668
176256a1 4669** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
3bbc50af
DL
4670`make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
4671typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
176256a1 4672
dd0add8e
DL
4673** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
4674characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
4675
699238d9 4676** New X resources recognized
100b3cbb 4677
7233c5bd
GM
4678*** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
4679whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
4680is useful for debugging X problems.
4681
4682Example:
4683
699238d9 4684 emacs.synchronous: true
7233c5bd 4685
100b3cbb
GM
4686*** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
4687visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
4688the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
4689and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
4690visual class names are
4691
4692 TrueColor
4693 PseudoColor
4694 DirectColor
4695 StaticColor
4696 GrayScale
4697 StaticGray
4698
4699Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
4700`pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
4701meaning.
4702
4703The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
4704supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
4705`visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
4706visual.
4707
4708Example:
4709
699238d9 4710 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
100b3cbb
GM
4711
4712*** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
4713specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
4714default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
4715resource values are `true' or `on'.
4716
4717Example:
4718
699238d9 4719 emacs.privateColormap: true
100b3cbb 4720
a933dad1
DL
4721** Faces and frame parameters.
4722
4723There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
4724Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
4725`scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
4726`scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
4727sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
4728for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
4729parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
4730
4731Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
4732`default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
79214ddf 4733`foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
a933dad1
DL
4734`default' face and vice versa.
4735
f77a4a8a
GM
4736** New face `menu'.
4737
4738The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
f77a4a8a 4739
a933dad1
DL
4740** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
4741
4742The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
4743colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
4744correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
4745the screen gamma of a frame's display.
4746
4747PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
4748in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
4749color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
4750
4751The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
4752`ScreenGamma'.
4753
a933dad1
DL
4754** Tabs and variable-width text.
4755
4756Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
4757defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
4758independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
4759Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
4760
4761** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
4762
4763*** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
4764
4765 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
4766
79dd1637
RS
4767The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
4768LessTif/Motif one.
a933dad1 4769
79dd1637
RS
4770*** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
4771LessTif and Motif.
a933dad1 4772
a933dad1
DL
4773** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
4774
4775As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
4776drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
4777`x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
4778
4779** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
efeb796b 4780bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
a933dad1
DL
4781
4782This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
4783`indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
4784variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
4785
4786** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
4787
4788When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
d9e66103 4789value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
a933dad1 4790number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
d5951185 4791fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
a933dad1
DL
4792
4793When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
8a33023e 4794value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
a933dad1 4795number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
d5951185 4796fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
a933dad1 4797
efeb796b
EZ
4798** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
4799M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
4800M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
4801buffers.
4802
4803** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
4804
4805** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
4806abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
4807`directory-abbrev-alist'.
4808
efeb796b
EZ
4809** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
4810the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
4811forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
4812value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
4813users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
4814even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
4815
4816The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
4817
a933dad1
DL
4818** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
4819notably at the end of lines.
4820
4821All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
4822spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
4823
8748ecc0 4824** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
eee54b0e 4825
8748ecc0
GM
4826** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
4827but inserts text instead of replacing it.
2ce72bfa 4828
a933dad1
DL
4829** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
4830query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
4831after each match to get the replacement text.
4832
d5483ab1
GM
4833** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
4834you edit the replacement string.
4ff40dd0 4835
75823f67
EZ
4836** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
4837(if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
4838in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
4ff40dd0 4839
efeb796b 4840** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
889be0a1 4841
efeb796b
EZ
4842** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
4843to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
327652be 4844
efeb796b
EZ
4845** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
4846the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
4847MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
4848displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
a32da22c 4849
75823f67 4850--
efeb796b
EZ
4851** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
4852read mail from the menu etc.
559cee90 4853
efeb796b
EZ
4854** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
4855This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
4856MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
4857before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
559cee90 4858
efeb796b
EZ
4859** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
4860MS-DOS version of Emacs.
424d8b44 4861
efeb796b
EZ
4862** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
4863of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
4864This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
4865correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
4866but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
4867of Emacs.
eb2aac9d 4868
efeb796b 4869** Customize changes
eb2aac9d 4870
efeb796b
EZ
4871*** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
4872`State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
4873M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
4874customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
4875earlier versions of Emacs.
1b24b888 4876
efeb796b
EZ
4877*** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
4878Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
4879default).
79c78e77 4880
efeb796b
EZ
4881*** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
4882does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
4883file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
4884wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
4885file.
79c78e77 4886
7e97c157
EZ
4887** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
4888does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
4889avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
4890already in your init file.
4891
efeb796b 4892** New features in evaluation commands
3476b54a 4893
efeb796b
EZ
4894*** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
4895modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
4896print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
4897customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
4898eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
a933dad1 4899
f37e8c77
EZ
4900The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
4901respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
4902the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
4903the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
4904printed).
4905
75c5350a
GM
4906<RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
4907printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
f6e6cdf2 4908
f37e8c77
EZ
4909The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
4910during evaluation produces a backtrace.
4911
3a426197 4912*** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5e03eb84
GM
4913code when called with a prefix argument.
4914
b1c609b1
GM
4915** CC mode changes.
4916
4917Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
4918current user setups (although it's believed that these
4919incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
4920However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
4921back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
4922compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
4923release.
4924
e120bebf
GM
4925*** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
4926CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
4927is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
4928confusion.
4929
4930However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
4931default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
4932java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
4933notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
4934
4935*** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
4936Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
4937
4938space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
4939parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
4940
4941compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
4942parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
4943It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
4944style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
4945
4946*** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
4947Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
4948"electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
4949earlier statement. An example:
4950
4951for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
4952 if (a[i])
4953 res += a[i]->offset;
4954else
4955
4956Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
4957continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
4958the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
4959possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
4960the preceding "if".
4961
4962CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
4963by default.
4964
4965*** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
4966Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
4967meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
4968documentation or other natural language text.
4969
4970The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
4971contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
4972the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
4973strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
4974to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
4975commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
4976sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
4977
4978*** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
4979Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
4980source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
4981comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
4982
4983*** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
4984When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
4985line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
4986change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
4987Pike mode only.
4988
4989*** Better handling of syntactic errors.
4990The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
4991improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
4992stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
4993following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
4994matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
4995indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
4996is reported afterwards.
4997
4998*** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
4999A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5000returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5001
5002*** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5003Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5004on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5005can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5006code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5007modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5008groundwork.
5009
7972fcfc
GM
5010*** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5011This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5012of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5013non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5014want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5015have to bother.
5016
5017Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5018situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
487522fe 5019and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
7972fcfc
GM
5020If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5021the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5022by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5023
b1c609b1
GM
5024*** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5025When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5026variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5027take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5028is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5029settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5030possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5031Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5032
5033By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5034special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5035the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5036of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5037above.
5038
5039Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5040when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5041function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5042call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5043then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5044values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5045only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5046function documentation for more info.
5047
5048The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5049especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5050with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5051intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5052such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5053is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5054configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5055global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5056
5057(Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5058
5059**** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5060This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5061
5062This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5063variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5064completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5065the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5066empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5067style system.
5068
5069**** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5070In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5071c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5072as far as possible.
5073
5074*** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5075CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5076surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5077chapter about this in the manual.
5078
5079**** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5080The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5081recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5082primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5083adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5084
5085**** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5086This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5087c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5088
5089**** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5090This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5091
5092It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5093Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5094A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5095inside CC Mode.
5096
5097Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5098causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5099the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5100available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5101cc-mode/).
5102
9ed462b7
EZ
5103**** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5104`c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5105enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5106function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5107they were before the filling.
5108
b1c609b1
GM
5109**** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5110The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5111specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5112literals.
5113
5114**** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5115It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5116prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
5117you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
5118this function.
5119
5120*** Fixes to IDL mode.
5121It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
5122to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
5123struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
5124Thanks to Eric Eide.
5125
5126*** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
5127It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
5128opening braces hangs and when they don't.
5129
5130**** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
5131
5132*** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
5133See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
5134better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
5135and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
5136
5137*** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
5138previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
5139the column specified by comment-column.
5140
5141*** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
5142In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
5143is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
5144prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
5145contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
5146don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
5147
5148*** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
5149instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
5150arguments.
5151
5152*** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
5153
5154*** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
5155c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
5156c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
5157variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
5158Provan).
5159
5160*** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
5161
efeb796b 5162** Dired changes
c407c570 5163
efeb796b
EZ
5164*** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
5165command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
5166is, delete only empty directories.
c407c570 5167
efeb796b
EZ
5168*** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
5169command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
5170copy directories recursively.
87be76f6 5171
efeb796b
EZ
5172*** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
5173in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
5174the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
3353ef5a 5175
efeb796b
EZ
5176*** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
5177replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
5178directory.
c407c570 5179
a320a8e7 5180*** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
efeb796b
EZ
5181a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
5182This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
5183will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
5184accurate or inaccurate as it is.
5185
5186*** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
5187from ls switches.
5188
5189*** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
5190of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
5191which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
5192source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
a933dad1 5193
efeb796b 5194** Gnus changes.
87be76f6 5195
efeb796b
EZ
5196The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
5197four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
5198internationalization and mail-fetching.
87be76f6 5199
efeb796b
EZ
5200*** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
5201many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
87be76f6 5202
efeb796b 5203If you used procmail like in
87be76f6 5204
efeb796b
EZ
5205(setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
5206(setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
5207(setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
5208(setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
35384f06 5209
efeb796b 5210this now has changed to
87be76f6 5211
efeb796b
EZ
5212(setq mail-sources
5213 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
5214 :suffix ".in")))
d7b511c4 5215
efeb796b
EZ
5216More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
5217Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
d67f47e4 5218
efeb796b
EZ
5219*** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
5220Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
5221Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
5222longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
d7b511c4 5223
efeb796b
EZ
5224The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
5225use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
5226installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
9d453139 5227
efeb796b
EZ
5228*** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
5229parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
5230are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
5231now just a compatibility layer.
4b9347b3 5232
75823f67
EZ
5233*** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
5234Gnus facilities.
5235
efeb796b
EZ
5236*** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
5237called to position point.
4b9347b3 5238
efeb796b
EZ
5239*** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
5240summary buffers and NOV files.
79214ddf 5241
efeb796b
EZ
5242*** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
5243of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
79214ddf 5244
efeb796b
EZ
5245*** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
5246subtly different manner.
aca0be23 5247
efeb796b
EZ
5248*** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
5249and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
5250ever-changing layouts.
79214ddf 5251
efeb796b 5252*** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
79214ddf 5253
efeb796b 5254*** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
8c463abe 5255
efeb796b 5256** Changes in Texinfo mode.
8c463abe 5257
efeb796b
EZ
5258*** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
5259macros
79214ddf 5260
efeb796b
EZ
5261 Key binding Macro
5262 -------------------------
5263 C-c C-c C-s @strong
5264 C-c C-c C-e @emph
5265 C-c C-c u @uref
5266 C-c C-c q @quotation
5267 C-c C-c m @email
5268 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
5269 M-RET @item
79214ddf 5270
efeb796b 5271*** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
79214ddf 5272
efeb796b 5273** Changes in Outline mode.
79214ddf 5274
efeb796b
EZ
5275There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
5276`outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
5277the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
89d57763 5278
efeb796b 5279** Changes to Emacs Server
79214ddf 5280
efeb796b
EZ
5281*** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
5282with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
5283are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
5284Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
5285buffers to kill, as before.
79214ddf 5286
efeb796b
EZ
5287Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
5288i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
5289this way.
5290
5291** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
5292of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
5293
5294** Changes to Show Paren mode.
5295
5296*** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
5297The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
5298use. Default is 1000.
79214ddf 5299
efeb796b
EZ
5300** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
5301groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
f6737cde 5302
efeb796b 5303** Changes to hideshow.el
3f6e4b8b 5304
efeb796b 5305*** Generalized block selection and traversal
f6737cde 5306
efeb796b
EZ
5307A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
5308and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
5309serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
5310See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
f6737cde 5311
efeb796b
EZ
5312*** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
5313hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
5314be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
5315the open block.
f6737cde 5316
efeb796b
EZ
5317*** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
5318function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
5319the normal block-hiding function.
f6737cde 5320
efeb796b 5321*** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
f6737cde 5322
efeb796b
EZ
5323*** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
5324roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
5325for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
5326for `hs-minor-mode'.
f6737cde 5327
efeb796b
EZ
5328*** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
5329hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
f6737cde 5330
efeb796b 5331** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
f6737cde 5332
efeb796b
EZ
5333*** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
5334an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
5335log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
0c68ce6f 5336
efeb796b
EZ
5337**** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
5338current buffer.
d521e087 5339
efeb796b
EZ
5340*** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
5341in a log file.
1e7db2e9 5342
efeb796b
EZ
5343*** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
5344entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
5345Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
5346version number is performed based on regular expressions from
5347`change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
5348Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
5349
5350*** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
5351
5352** Changes to cmuscheme
5353
5354*** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
5355`cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
5356
5357** Changes in Font Lock
5358
5359*** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
5360font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
5361
5362*** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
5363set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
5364
5365*** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
5366the face used for each string/comment.
5367
5368*** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
5369Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
5370
5371** Changes to Shell mode
5372
5373*** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
5374to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
5375non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
5376prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
5377
5378** Comint (subshell) changes
5379
5380These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
5381include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
5382
5383*** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
5384Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
5385BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
5386beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
5387respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
5388the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
5389
5390*** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
5391to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
5392parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
5393user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
5394this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
5395respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
5396feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
5397`comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
5398
5399*** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
5400and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
5401
5402*** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
5403buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
5404buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
5405
5406The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
5407M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
5408the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
5409
5410*** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
5411and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
5412see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
5413
5414*** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
5415saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
5416argument, it appends to the file.
5417
5418*** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
5419(usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
5420compatibility.
5421
5422*** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
5423ring (history).
5424
5425*** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
5426identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
5427strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
5428
5429** Changes to Rmail mode
5430
5431*** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
5432set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
5433receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
5434recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
5435`user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
5436as correspondent.
5437
5438Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
5439mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
5440regexp matching your mail addresses.
5441
5442*** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
5443to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
5444Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
5445with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
5446for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
5447
5448*** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
5449like `j'.
5450
5451*** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
5452specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
5453digest message.
5454
5455*** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
5456in which folder to put messages automatically.
5457
5458*** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
5459with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
5460due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
5461
5462** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
5463an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
5464
75823f67
EZ
5465** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
5466use the -f option when sending mail.
5467
f68113db
EZ
5468** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
5469current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
5470the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
5471This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
5472by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
5473displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
5474
5475If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
5476other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
5477`rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
5478
efeb796b
EZ
5479** Changes to TeX mode
5480
5481*** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
5482`latex-mode'.
5483
5484*** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
5485
5486*** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
5487
5488*** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
5489
5490** Changes to RefTeX mode
5491
5492*** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
5493 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
5494 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
5495 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
5496 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
5497 can be edited from that buffer.
5498
5499*** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
5500 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
5501 `A' to use all marked entries).
5502
5503*** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
5504 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
5505
5506*** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
5507 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
5508 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
5509 been cited.
5510
5511** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
5512The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
5513semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
5514in column 1 are always made leaves.
5515
5516** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
5517has the following new features:
5518
5519*** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
5520may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
5521to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
5522time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
5523
5524*** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
5525feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
5526file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
5527compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
5528pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
5529defaults to 1.
5530
5531** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
5532file names.
5533
5534** Ispell changes
fbc164de 5535
efeb796b
EZ
5536*** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
5537transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
5538spell-checks the current buffer.
59c1bf85 5539
efeb796b
EZ
5540*** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
5541added.
732b9cdd 5542
efeb796b
EZ
5543*** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
5544correction is made and re-checked.
b8b2ea31 5545
4cdf4bde 5546*** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
b8b2ea31 5547
efeb796b
EZ
5548*** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
5549cases.
b8b2ea31 5550
efeb796b
EZ
5551*** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
5552on syntax errors.
5553
5554*** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
5555end of the buffer.
5556
5557*** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5558
efeb796b
EZ
5559** Makefile mode changes
5560
5561*** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
b8b2ea31 5562
efeb796b
EZ
5563*** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
5564Fontlock mode is active.
1e406be0 5565
efeb796b 5566** Isearch changes
e33b0397 5567
efeb796b
EZ
5568*** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
5569so that searches can be resumed.
e33b0397 5570
3a426197 5571*** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
efeb796b
EZ
5572respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
5573that started the search.
5574
5575*** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
5576selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6f8ea2ae 5577
efeb796b 5578*** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
c0510d27 5579
efeb796b
EZ
5580Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
5581`isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
5582search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
5583before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
5584highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
5585`secondary-selection'.
5d94f558 5586
efeb796b
EZ
5587The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
5588will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
5589Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
5590using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
5591usual snappy response.
dc28878c 5592
efeb796b
EZ
5593If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
5594matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
5595set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
5596isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
95931eb1 5597
54baed30
GM
5598** VC Changes
5599
5600VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
5601easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
5602Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
5603to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
5604changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
60a441a5 5605`vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
54baed30
GM
5606version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
5607each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
5608file is registered in that backend.
5609
5610When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
5611backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
5612directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
5613master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
5614the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
5615As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
5616
5617The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
5618still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
5619RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
5620vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
5621where it doesn't make sense.)
5622
5623The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
5624obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
5625`CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
5626
5627*** General Changes
5628
5629The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
5630checks are always done now.
5631
327652be 5632VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
54baed30
GM
5633operations.
5634
c286608e
SM
5635`vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
5636`vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
5637`vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
5638
22933be8
AS
5639The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
5640first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
5641current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
5642the working file (``merge news'').
5643
5644The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5645(vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
5646downwards.
5647
5648*** Multiple Backends
5649
5650VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
5651useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
5652repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
5653commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
5654local RCS archives.
5655
5656To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
5657should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
5658backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
5659`vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
5660
60a441a5
AS
5661You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
5662C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
5663a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
5664if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
5665current revision number from the more remote backend.
22933be8
AS
5666
5667If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
5668another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
5669any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
5670pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
5671
5672After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
5673changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
5674local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
5675buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
5676
54baed30
GM
5677*** Changes for CVS
5678
5679There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
5680default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
5681remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
5682by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
5683regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
5684that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
5685queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
5686
22933be8
AS
5687If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
5688repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
5689revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
5690any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
5691backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
5692number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
5693(vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
5694of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
5695the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
105602b1
EZ
5696automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
5697since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
5698name.)
22933be8 5699
54baed30
GM
5700If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
5701repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
5702If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
22933be8 5703commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
54baed30
GM
5704current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
5705entire directory tree.
5706
5707The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
5708"cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
5709is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
5710"watched" by other developers.)
5711
22933be8
AS
5712The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5713(vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
60a441a5 5714an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
22933be8
AS
5715starting at the given directory.
5716
54baed30
GM
5717*** Lisp Changes in VC
5718
5719VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
5720add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
5721library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
5722then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
60a441a5
AS
5723a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
5724provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
54baed30 5725of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
60a441a5
AS
5726you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
5727`SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
54baed30 5728
c4ed232b 5729** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
732b9cdd
GM
5730SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
5731terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
5732See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
5733
a933dad1
DL
5734** New modes and packages
5735
79b9f6e0
MB
5736*** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
5737automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
5738the default is not applicable.
5739
b95b34e5
GM
5740*** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
5741rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
5742shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
5743
5744Features are:
5745
5746- Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
5747 drawn, like this: | \ /
c607d53d 5748 --+-- X
b95b34e5
GM
5749 | / \
5750
5751- Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
5752 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
5753 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
5754 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
5755 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
5756 you are drawing.
5757
5758- Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
5759 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
5760
5761- Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
5762 flood-filling.
5763
5764- Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
5765 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
5766 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
5767 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
c607d53d 5768
b95b34e5
GM
5769- Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
5770 also do without the mouse.
5771
5772- Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
5773 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
5774 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
5775 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
5776 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
5777
5778- Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
5779
5780 lines straight-lines
5781 rectangles squares
5782 poly-lines straight poly-lines
5783 ellipses circles
5784 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
5785 spray-can setting size for spraying
5786 vaporize line vaporize lines
5787 erase characters erase rectangles
5788
5789 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
5790 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
5791 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
5792 drawing.
5793
5794 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
5795 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
5796 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
5797 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
5798
5799- Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
5800 can be turned off).
5801
4473cdd9
JW
5802*** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
5803implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
5804It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
5805functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
5806history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
5807will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
5808the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
5809rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
5810all within the scope of your Emacs process.
5811
90cbf47e
GM
5812*** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
5813intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
5814typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
5815on certain projects.
5816
baf7eee4
GM
5817*** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
5818of interactively entered regexps. For example,
abb2db1c 5819
d96d6bb0 5820 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
abb2db1c
GM
5821
5822will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
5823face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
5824typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
5825Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
5826appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
5827current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
baf7eee4
GM
5828corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
5829to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
abb2db1c 5830
d96d6bb0 5831*** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
abb2db1c
GM
5832Emacs is idle.
5833
b4c3513f
EZ
5834*** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
5835fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
5836
31fc5d15
GM
5837*** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
5838parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
5839
5cb6a58e
SM
5840*** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
5841package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
5842be more robust while offering the same functionality.
601e0081
SM
5843`comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
5844comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
5cb6a58e 5845
578979ee
GM
5846*** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
5847facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
5848separate Texinfo file.
5849
424d8b44
DL
5850*** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
5851by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
5852provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
5853`log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
8a33023e 5854enter check-in log messages.
dc1178bf 5855
6abca616
EZ
5856*** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
5857without invoking external programs.
5858
5859The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
5860and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
5861`manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
5862is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
490f2e7b 5863Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6abca616
EZ
5864
5865The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
5866page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
5867
5e5dff44
GM
5868*** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
5869authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
5870
5871The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
5872the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
5873the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
5874Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
5875even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
5876single step.
5877
5878On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
5879matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
5880probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
5881contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
5882
f7136ee8
GM
5883*** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
5884unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
5885actually modifying content of a buffer.
5886
bbd9b566
GM
5887*** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
5888PostScript.
5889
5890Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
5891
5892The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
5893
5894 ; comment (until end of line)
5895 A non-terminal
5896 "C" terminal
5897 ?C? special
5898 $A default non-terminal
5899 $"C" default terminal
5900 $?C? default special
5901 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
5902 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
5903 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
5904 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
5905 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
5906 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
5907 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
5908 C+ one or more occurrences of C
5909 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
5910 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
5911 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
5912 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
5913 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
5914 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
5915 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
5916
5917Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
5918
99453a38
GM
5919*** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
5920align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
5921determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
5922example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
5923equal signs of assignments.
5924
559cee90
DL
5925*** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
5926paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
5927
6448a6b3
GM
5928*** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
5929list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
2018166d 5930buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6448a6b3 5931
6344985d
GM
5932*** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
5933
249652b1
GM
5934*** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
5935replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
5936is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
5937and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
5938not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
5939which answers different needs.
5940
3476b54a
GM
5941*** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
5942suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
5943expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
5944course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
5945reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
5946to be enabled.
5947
8964fec7
SM
5948*** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
5949containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
5950
a933dad1
DL
5951*** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
5952
16837afc
GM
5953*** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
5954current line in the current buffer. It also provides
dfd67a62 5955`global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
a933dad1
DL
5956
5957*** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
5958
fba448c1 5959Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
8901d1ac
GM
5960`global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
5961disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
5962`comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
5963displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
5964and background colors.
5965
a933dad1
DL
5966*** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
5967Pascal) language.
5968
5969*** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
5970the text at point.
5971
5972*** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
5973
8d54eb69
DL
5974*** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
5975
732b9cdd
GM
5976*** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
5977whitespace in a file.
a933dad1 5978
ebcfda83
GM
5979*** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
5980files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
5981(very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
5982interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
5983often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
5984uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
5985codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
5986
5987*** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
5988
5989Here is an example of columns:
5990
5991horse apple bus
5992dog pineapple car EXTRA
5993porcupine strawberry airplane
5994
5995Doing the following settings:
5996
5997 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
5998 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
5999 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6000 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6001
6002
6003Selecting the lines above and typing:
6004
6005 M-x delimit-columns-region
6006
6007It results:
6008
6009[ horse , apple , bus , ]
6010[ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6011[ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6012
6013delim-col has the following options:
6014
6015 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6016 before all columns.
6017
6018 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6019 between each column.
6020
6021 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6022 after all columns.
6023
6024 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6025 each column.
6026
6027delim-col has the following commands:
6028
6029 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6030 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6031
2018166d
DL
6032*** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6033operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6034menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6035recent file list can be displayed:
f507826c 6036
31fc5d15 6037- organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
8a33023e
GM
6038- sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6039- showing paths relative to the current default-directory
f507826c 6040
31fc5d15
GM
6041The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6042dynamically change the menu appearance.
f507826c 6043
8062f458
DL
6044*** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6045text.
6046
36e24b82 6047*** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
91735437
DL
6048of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6049specific to Message mode.
6050
36e24b82
DL
6051*** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6052viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6053with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6054
aaa659ef
DL
6055*** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6056interface to access directory servers using different directory
6057protocols. It has a separate manual.
6058
eee54b0e
DL
6059*** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6060for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6061
612839b6
GM
6062*** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6063
5d94f558 6064*** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
612839b6 6065minibuffer with completion.
aaa659ef 6066
399da7e3
DL
6067*** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6068with the diary features.
6069
6e417ca5
DL
6070*** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6071numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6072
4a27bdfb
GM
6073*** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6074Fill mode.
6075
dace60cf
JW
6076*** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6077facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6078difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6079they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
a18a342d 6080
9540ec3f
EZ
6081*** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6082It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6083`.g'.
6084
efeb796b
EZ
6085** Changes in sort.el
6086
6087The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6088as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6089new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6090numeric base.
6091
6092** Changes to Ange-ftp
6093
efeb796b
EZ
6094*** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6095names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6096sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6097
6098*** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6099ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6100
6101*** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6102output ^M at the end of lines.
6103
efeb796b
EZ
6104** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6105mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6106
efeb796b
EZ
6107** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6108If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6109`(msb-mode 1)'.
6110
6111** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6112group.
6113
6114** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6115behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6116are recognized:
6117
6118`untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
6119`hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
6120`all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
6121nil -- just delete one character.
6122
6123Default value is `untabify'.
6124
6125[This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
6126
6127** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
6128symbol, not double-quoted.
6129
6130** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
6131version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
6132profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
6133moved to lisp/obsolete.
6134
6135** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
6136To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
6137`auto-compression-mode' command.
6138
6139** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
6140`browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
6141`browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
6142
6143** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
6144`browse-url-new-window-flag'.
6145
efeb796b
EZ
6146** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
6147operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
6148
efeb796b
EZ
6149** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
6150is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
6151
6152** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
6153support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
6154use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
6155buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
6156M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
6157new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
6158
efeb796b
EZ
6159** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
6160a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
6161
6162** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
6163
6164The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
6165file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
6166
6167** Shell script mode changes.
6168
6169Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
6170derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
6171sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
6172
6173** Etags changes.
6174
6175*** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
6176
6177*** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
6178possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
6179{lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
6180This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
6181a regular expression. The manual contains details.
6182
6183*** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
6184declarations when given the --declarations option.
6185
6186*** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
6187"operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
6188
6189*** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
6190automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
6191`template' keywords.
6192
6193*** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
6194C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
6195
6196*** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
6197types.
6198
6199*** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
6200
6201*** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
6202
6203*** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
6204are now tagged.
6205
6206*** In makefiles, tags the targets.
6207
6208*** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
6209variables are tagged.
6210
6211*** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
6212
6213*** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
6214for PSWrap.
6215
efeb796b
EZ
6216** Changes in etags.el
6217
6218*** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
6219tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
6220is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
6221
6222*** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
6223the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
6224
6225If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
6226FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
6227TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
6228obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
6229
6230TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
6231
6232FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
6233List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
6234
6235A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
6236
6237 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
6238 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
6239 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
6240
6241*** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
6242of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
6243
6244*** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
6245names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
6246
6247*** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
6248If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
6249/tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
6250"dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
6251point will go to the beginning of the file.
6252
6253*** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
6254auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
6255(with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
6256
6257*** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
6258in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
6259found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
6260
efeb796b
EZ
6261** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
6262remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
6263appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
6264
6265** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
6266
efeb796b
EZ
6267** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
6268
efeb796b
EZ
6269** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
6270containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
6271expression from that list, are not checked.
6272
6273** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
6274When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
6275and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
6276the buffer, just like for the local files.
6277
6278** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
6279
efeb796b
EZ
6280** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
6281displays local abbrevs, only.
6282
965bc065
DL
6283** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
6284paragraphs filled as you modify them.
6285
4e8864c7
GM
6286** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
6287may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
6288is measured in pixels.
6289
965bc065
DL
6290** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
6291to be visited as images.
6292
68d0efa6
GM
6293** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
6294were added to compile.el.
6295
a933dad1
DL
6296** Withdrawn packages
6297
6298*** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
6299functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
25a81338 6300
3261c1d8
DL
6301*** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
6302
6303*** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
ce75fd23 6304
05197f40 6305\f
01242779
DL
6306* Incompatible Lisp changes
6307
6308There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
6309may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
3b6936cc 6310See the sections below for details.
01242779 6311
89d57763 6312** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
9b2a085d 6313`(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
bd1190d7
RS
6314Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
6315to remove the properties of the copy.
01242779
DL
6316
6317** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
6318which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
6319may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
6320these properties are active.
6321
4dd4cc14 6322** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
01242779 6323ranges may affect some code.
1c14ba45
DL
6324
6325** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
6326buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
6327make a difference to some code.
6328
4dd4cc14
DL
6329** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
6330operates on the minibuffer.
6331
7c94ccf6
EZ
6332** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6333cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
6334different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
6335(previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
6336Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
6337character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
6338multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
6339encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
6340reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
6341sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
6342a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
6343the buffer as multibyte characters.
6344
6345Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
6346MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
6347appropriate for reading truly binary files.
6348
7a39158f 6349** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
3280fbe8
EZ
6350`after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
6351`before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7a39158f
DL
6352
6353** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
539e74f9
EZ
6354long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
6355such as `mapconcat'.
7a39158f 6356
55bb62fd
EZ
6357** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
6358string.
6359
f34eb373
DL
6360** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
6361extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
6362dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
6363one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
6364charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
6365the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
028d739a
DL
6366encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
6367probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
3478eafc 6368
98384b7b
EZ
6369** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
6370Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
6371aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
6372not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
6373on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
6374behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
6375turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
6376remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
6377advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
6378will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7cd5f1e7 6379
05197f40 6380\f
ce75fd23
GM
6381* Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
6382(Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
6383
e3b22517
GM
6384** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
6385
1ff74324 6386** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
9e5a7f2a
GM
6387allows the animated display of strings.
6388
ed31fabf
GM
6389** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
6390interactive form of a function.
6391
2018166d
DL
6392** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
6393between custom options. Example:
6394
6395 (defcustom default-input-method nil
6396 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
6397 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
6398 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
6399 :group 'mule
6400 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
6401 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
6402
6403This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
6404current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
6405first in a custom-set-variables statement.
6406
f3780fe4 6407** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
a758f97d
GM
6408function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
6409args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
6410(signal or normal termination).
6411
023045d6
DL
6412** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
6413from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
6414
eb1b0c74
GM
6415** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6416to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6417
52d89894
GM
6418** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
6419alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
6420
693c4692 6421** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
4301cf66 6422
6bc92b2e
GM
6423** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
6424deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
6425being deleted.
6426
39e776cd
SM
6427** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
6428
1396138a 6429** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
a18a342d
DL
6430If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
6431skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
6432with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
6433C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
6434charset.
6435
4fbdfdcf
MB
6436** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
6437the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
6438message.
6439
6a0b0752
MB
6440** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
6441expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
6442
47e351a3
GM
6443** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
6444with the more general `:mask' property.
6445
f864120f 6446** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
ba9eeda1 6447
a2bd77b8
GM
6448** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
6449backslash.
6450
424d8b44
DL
6451** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
6452is running in batch mode. For example,
6453
6454 (message "%s" (read t))
6455
6456will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
6457to standard output.
6458
424d8b44
DL
6459** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
6460`kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
6461
ead53494
GM
6462** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
6463will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
6464frame or window.
6465
27848c01
GM
6466** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
6467were added
6468
6469- Function: remove ELT SEQ
6470
8a33023e 6471Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
27848c01
GM
6472a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
6473
6474- Function: remq ELT LIST
6475
8a33023e 6476Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
27848c01
GM
6477comparison is done with `eq'.
6478
6479** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
3ab82477 6480
b548072f 6481** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
c8682017 6482has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
92d2f186 6483`key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
b548072f 6484
07b14857
KH
6485** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
6486without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
6487convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
6488
9662da0b
GM
6489** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
6490or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
d5aa31d8 6491
7fce7efb
DL
6492** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
6493function was declared obsolete.
6494
5d94f558 6495** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7fce7efb
DL
6496retained as an alias).
6497
593b3517
RS
6498** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
6499the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
f98d3086 6500
87efd256
GM
6501** The new function `window-list' has been defined
6502
39b39373
GM
6503- Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
6504
6505Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
6506omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
6507the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
6508even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
6509minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
6510means never include the minibuffer window.
87efd256 6511
a56ebb90 6512** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
67c9a1d2 6513
a56ebb90 6514- Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
67c9a1d2
GM
6515
6516Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
6517
6518This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
6519calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
6520argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
6521value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
6522returned.
6523
6524Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
6525if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
6526it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
6527minibuffer even if it is active.
6528
6529Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
6530counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
6531too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
6532and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
6533`walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
6534entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
6535
6536ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
6537ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
6538ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
6539ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
6540ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
6541If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
6542Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
6543
ead53494
GM
6544** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
6545event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
6546argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
dce6b995 6547
25fa6deb
GM
6548** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
6549call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
088831a6
GM
6550message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
6551Default value is nil.
25fa6deb 6552
5d94f558 6553** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
1681ead6
GM
6554meaning no limit.
6555
5b034b7f
EZ
6556** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
6557the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
6558numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
6559
5d94f558 6560** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
c08398de
DL
6561coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
6562DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
6563
9b2999d0
DL
6564** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
6565list of a primitive.
de370c4c 6566
c286608e
SM
6567** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
6568
80c05bd3
DL
6569** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
6570buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
6571This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
6572than replacing the local map.
6573
14fd0da3
DL
6574** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
6575`after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
6576removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
6577instead.
45f485a6
GM
6578
6579** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
6580
c286608e
SM
6581** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
6582as promised long ago.
f0298744 6583
5d94f558 6584** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
ac57988b
GM
6585
6586** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
6587for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
6588patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
6589
05197f40 6590\f
a933dad1
DL
6591* Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
6592
6260538e
GM
6593** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
6594regular expressions.
6595
6596- Function: rx-to-string SEXP
6597
6598Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
6599
6600- Macro: rx SEXP
6601
6602Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
6603
6604The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
6605notation.
6606
6607STRING
6608 matches string STRING literally.
6609
6610CHAR
6611 matches character CHAR literally.
6612
6613`not-newline'
6614 matches any character except a newline.
6615 .
6616`anything'
6617 matches any character
6618
6619`(any SET)'
6620 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
6621 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
6622
79014980 6623'(in SET)'
6260538e
GM
6624 like `any'.
6625
6626`(not (any SET))'
6627 matches any character not in SET
6628
6629`line-start'
6630 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
6631 in the text being matched
6632
6633`line-end'
6634 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
6635
6636`string-start'
6637 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6638 string being matched against.
6639
6640`string-end'
6641 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6642 string being matched against.
6643
6644`buffer-start'
6645 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6646 buffer being matched against.
6647
6648`buffer-end'
6649 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6650 buffer being matched against.
6651
6652`point'
6653 matches the empty string, but only at point.
6654
6655`word-start'
6656 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6657 word.
6658
6659`word-end'
6660 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
6661
6662`word-boundary'
6663 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6664 word.
6665
6666`(not word-boundary)'
6667 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
6668 word.
6669
6670`digit'
6671 matches 0 through 9.
6672
6673`control'
6674 matches ASCII control characters.
6675
6676`hex-digit'
6677 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
6678
6679`blank'
6680 matches space and tab only.
6681
6682`graphic'
6683 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
6684 space, and DEL.
6685
6686`printing'
6687 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
6688 and DEL.
6689
6690`alphanumeric'
6691 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6692 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6693
6694`letter'
6695 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6696 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
6697
6698`ascii'
6699 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
6700
6701`nonascii'
6702 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
6703
6704`lower'
6705 matches anything lower-case.
6706
6707`upper'
6708 matches anything upper-case.
6709
6710`punctuation'
6711 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
6712 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
6713
6714`space'
6715 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
6716
6717`word'
6718 matches anything that has word syntax.
6719
6720`(syntax SYNTAX)'
6721 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
6722 of the following symbols.
6723
6724 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
6725 `punctuation' (\\s.)
6726 `word' (\\sw)
6727 `symbol' (\\s_)
6728 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
6729 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
6730 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
6731 `string-quote' (\\s\")
6732 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
6733 `escape' (\\s\\)
6734 `character-quote' (\\s/)
6735 `comment-start' (\\s<)
6736 `comment-end' (\\s>)
6737
6738`(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
6739 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
6740
6741`(category CATEGORY)'
6742 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
6743 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
6744
6745 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
6746 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
6747 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
6748 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
6749 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
6750 `symbol' (\\c5)
6751 `digit' (\\c6)
6752 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
6753 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
6754 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
6755 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
6756 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
6757 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
6758 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
6759 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
6760 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
175573ac 6761 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
6260538e
GM
6762 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
6763 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
6764 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
6765 `ascii' (\\ca)
6766 `arabic' (\\cb)
6767 `chinese' (\\cc)
6768 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
6769 `greek' (\\cg)
6770 `korean' (\\ch)
6771 `indian' (\\ci)
6772 `japanese' (\\cj)
6773 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
6774 `latin' (\\cl)
6775 `lao' (\\co)
6776 `tibetan' (\\cq)
6777 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
6778 `thai' (\\ct)
6779 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
6780 `hebrew' (\\cw)
6781 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
6782 `can-break' (\\c|)
6783
6784`(not (category CATEGORY))'
6785 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
6786
6787`(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6788 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
6789
6790`(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6791 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
6792 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
6793
6794`(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6795 another name for `submatch'.
6796
6797`(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
6798 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
6799 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
6800 regular expression.
6801
6802`(minimal-match SEXP)'
6803 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
e0e7f2d5 6804 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
6260538e
GM
6805 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
6806 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
6807
6808`(maximal-match SEXP)'
c3518b63 6809 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
6260538e
GM
6810
6811`(zero-or-more SEXP)'
6812 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6813
6814`(0+ SEXP)'
6815 like `zero-or-more'.
6816
6817`(* SEXP)'
6818 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6819
6820`(*? SEXP)'
6821 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6822
6823`(one-or-more SEXP)'
6824 matches one or more occurrences of A.
79014980 6825
6260538e
GM
6826`(1+ SEXP)'
6827 like `one-or-more'.
6828
6829`(+ SEXP)'
6830 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6831
6832`(+? SEXP)'
6833 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6834
6835`(zero-or-one SEXP)'
6836 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
79014980 6837
6260538e
GM
6838`(optional SEXP)'
6839 like `zero-or-one'.
6840
6841`(? SEXP)'
6842 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
6843
6844`(?? SEXP)'
6845 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
6846
6847`(repeat N SEXP)'
6848 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6849
6850`(repeat N M SEXP)'
6851 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
6852
6853`(eval FORM)'
c3518b63 6854 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
6260538e
GM
6855 `regexp-quote' it.
6856
6857`(regexp REGEXP)'
6858 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
6859
697617d9
GM
6860*** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
6861
85c75536
MB
6862*** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
6863buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
6864the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
6865restriction to be restored incorrectly.
6866
0b8a3a6d
DL
6867*** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
6868`eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
028d739a 6869when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
0b8a3a6d
DL
6870multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
6871
fb2c6a6b 6872*** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
58008c36
EZ
6873`string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
6874if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
0b8a3a6d
DL
6875
6876*** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
6877changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
6878[\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
6879regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
6880the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
6881extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
6882bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
6883eight-bit-graphic.
6884
6885** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
6886
9b2a085d 6887A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
0b8a3a6d
DL
6888a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
6889character set as previously.
6890
6891*** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
6892They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
6893modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
6894
6895CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
6896characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
6897range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
6898case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
6899
6900FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
9b2a085d 6901name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
0b8a3a6d
DL
6902
6903*** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
6904registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
6905"fontset-default".
6906
6907*** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
6908argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
6909
6910** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
6911composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
6912buffers and strings.
6913
6914*** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
6915character' which is an independent character with a unique character
6916code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
6917have been deleted: composite-char-component,
6918composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
6919composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
6920The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
6921also been deleted.
6922
6923*** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
6924specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
6925`reference-point-alist' for more detail.
6926
6927*** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
6928MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
6929composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
6930may differ between buffer and string text.
6931
6932*** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
6933COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
6934
6935*** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
6936directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
6937Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
6938`composition' from STRING.
6939
6940*** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
6941a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
6942
6943*** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
6944obsolete.
6945
889be0a1
DL
6946** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
6947the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
6948
965bc065 6949** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
1e36ff68
DL
6950`mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
6951introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
6952U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
0b8a3a6d 6953
3d7a4ec8
EZ
6954Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
6955characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
6956etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
6957different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
6958which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
6959encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
6960
6961** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
6962It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
6963details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
23cfab61 6964
0b8a3a6d 6965** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
1e36ff68
DL
6966`japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
6967standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
6968
6969** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
6970have been introduced.
0b8a3a6d 6971
0b8a3a6d 6972** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
1e36ff68 6973have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
028d739a
DL
69740xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
6975eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
6976emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
2018166d
DL
6977buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
6978eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
6979must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
6980their multibyte equivalent.
0b8a3a6d 6981
f0124b4a
DL
6982** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
6983that offset in the file before writing.
6984
f98d3086
SM
6985** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
6986compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7464346d 6987
612839b6
GM
6988** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
6989`*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
6990from which the command was issued.
6991
6992** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
6993`query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
6994`replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
6995additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
6996operate on.
6997
271b4185
GM
6998** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
6999to `window-buffer-height'.
7000
7001- Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7002
7003Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7004The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7005lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7006
7007Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7008respectively.
7009
8a33023e 7010If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
271b4185
GM
7011COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7012
7013The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7014obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7015on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7016
7017Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7018buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7019possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7020is currently displayed in some window.
7021
3c30cb6e
DL
7022** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7023argument function's results.
7024
62f20204 7025** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
55bb62fd 7026signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
c8682017
EZ
7027`base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
702820, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
55bb62fd 7029sequence).
62f20204 7030
c0510d27 7031** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
b4da8dfa 7032header in the list of headers passed to it.
c0510d27
GM
7033
7034** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7035ignores differences in case and text representation.
7036
7037** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
19d1bc27
GM
7038cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7039as follows:
7040
7041 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7042 nil don't display a cursor
7043 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7044 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7045 others display a box cursor.
7046
9a0dd3dc
GM
7047** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7048an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7049defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7050set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7051
d7b511c4 7052** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
dc1178bf 7053specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
d7b511c4
GM
7054the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7055text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7056
7057Example:
7058
7059 (string-to-syntax "()")
7060 => (4 . 41)
7061
1fa28578
GM
7062** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7063other than 10.
7064
7065*** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7066INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7067
5d94f558 7068 #b1111
1fa28578 7069 => 15
5d94f558 7070 #b-1111
1fa28578
GM
7071 => -15
7072
7073*** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7074
5d94f558 7075 #o666
1fa28578
GM
7076 => 438
7077
7078*** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7079
5d94f558 7080 #xbeef
1fa28578
GM
7081 => 48815
7082
7083*** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7084
5d94f558 7085 #2R-111
1fa28578 7086 => -7
5d94f558 7087 #25rah
1fa28578
GM
7088 => 267
7089
3d4ff2dd 7090** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
f98d3086 7091the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
e9b4e5ff
GM
7092and isn't a string.
7093
3d4ff2dd
GM
7094** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7095a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7096value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7097not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7098
16ce590d
DL
7099** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7100
73825616 7101** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
16ce590d
DL
7102for a regexp in a string.
7103
7104** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7105`mouse-position-function'.
7106
723e779c
GM
7107** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7108that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7109
d1e103b2
GM
7110** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7111Keywords are now always considered constants.
7112
31047e0d
DL
7113** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7114returns it.
7115
7a85e4df
GM
7116** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
7117returned by function `recent-keys'.
7118
02b14400
RS
7119** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
7120can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
3a426197 7121Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
02b14400
RS
7122etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
7123mode.
404fa7d6 7124
8964fec7
SM
7125** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
7126and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
7127
02b14400
RS
7128** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
7129has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
7130function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
7131returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
7132been performed."
7133
7134When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
7135and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
7136hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
7137then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
ef961722 7138
81da8b32
GM
7139** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
7140In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
7141and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
7142
9e207b90
GM
7143** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
7144with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
7145specified table.
7146
7147 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
7148
7149Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
03d9c64c
GM
7150TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
7151saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
7152what BODY returns.
9e207b90 7153
d7f89643 7154** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
95cd4c40 7155Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8a33023e 7156Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
601e0081
SM
7157corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
7158Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8964fec7 7159
dde9e75a
GM
7160** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
7161removed since it wasn't used by anything.
7162
9da30515
GM
7163** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
7164instead of being optional.
7165
d20679eb
GM
7166** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
7167modify read-only text.
7168
fbc164de
PE
7169** New functions and variables for locales.
7170
7171The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
7172decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
b718982a
PE
7173time functions like strftime. The new variables
7174`system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
7175locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
fbc164de
PE
7176
7177The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
7178environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
7179the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
b718982a
PE
7180environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
7181not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
7182`locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
7183`locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
fbc164de 7184
863476d1
SM
7185** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
7186To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
7187modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
7188start sequences.
7189
ef6d912c
GM
7190** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
7191because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
7192
a933dad1
DL
7193** New function `propertize'
7194
7195The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
7196strings with text properties.
7197
7198- Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
7199
7200Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
7201by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
7202PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
7203specified value of that property. Example:
7204
7205 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
7206
a933dad1
DL
7207** push and pop macros.
7208
02b14400
RS
7209Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
7210are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
a933dad1
DL
7211as the place that holds the list to be changed.
7212
7213(push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
7214(pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
7215 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
7216
02b14400
RS
7217** New dolist and dotimes macros.
7218
6c7fd5aa
RS
7219Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
7220are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
02b14400
RS
7221
7222(dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
7223 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
7224 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
7225 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7226
7227(dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
7228 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
7229 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
7230 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7231
6c083b4c
GM
7232** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
7233[:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
7234class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
7235or a sign.
a933dad1
DL
7236
7237[:digit:] matches 0 through 9
7238[:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
7239[:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7240[:blank:] matches space and tab only
7241[:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7242 space, and DEL.
7243[:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7244 and DEL.
7245[:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
7246 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7247 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7248[:alpha:] matches letters.
7249 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7250 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7251[:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7252[:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7253[:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
7254[:punct:] matches punctuation.
7255 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7256 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7257[:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7258[:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
7259[:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
7260
a933dad1
DL
7261** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
7262
7263The following functions are defined for hash tables:
7264
7265- Function: make-hash-table ARGS
7266
7267The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
7268are optional. The following arguments are defined:
7269
7270:test TEST
7271
7272TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
7273Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
7274it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
7275
7276:size SIZE
7277
7278SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
7279many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
7280
7281:rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
7282
7283REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
7284full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
7285size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
72861.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
7287old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
7288
7289:rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
7290
7291THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
7292hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
7293(size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
7294
7295:weakness WEAK
7296
b548072f
GM
7297WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
7298`key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
7299`key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
7300collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
7301outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
a933dad1
DL
7302
7303- Function: makehash &optional TEST
7304
7305Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
7306
7307- Function: hash-table-p TABLE
7308
7309Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
7310
7311- Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
7312
7313Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
7314values are shared.
7315
7316- Function: hash-table-count TABLE
7317
7318Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
7319
7320- Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7321
7322Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
7323
7324- Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
7325
7326Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
7327
7328- Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7329
7330Returns the size of TABLE.
7331
d96d6bb0 7332- Function: hash-table-test TABLE
a933dad1
DL
7333
7334Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
7335
7336- Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
7337
7338Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
7339
7340- Function: clrhash TABLE
7341
7342Clear TABLE.
7343
7344- Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
7345
7346Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
7347not found.
7348
79214ddf 7349- Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
a933dad1
DL
7350
7351Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
7352another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
7353
7354- Function: remhash KEY TABLE
7355
7356Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
7357
7358- Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
7359
7360Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
7361arguments KEY and VALUE.
7362
7363- Function: sxhash OBJ
7364
7365Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
7366
7367- Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
7368
7369Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
7370a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
79214ddf 7371comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
a933dad1
DL
7372and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
7373of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
7374
7375TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
7376
7377HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
7378code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
7379integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
7380
7381Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
7382be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
7383
7384 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
7385 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
7386
7387 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
7388 (sxhash (upcase a)))
7389
79214ddf 7390 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
a933dad1
DL
7391 'case-fold-string-hash))
7392
7393 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
7394
a933dad1
DL
7395** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
7396
7397It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
7398circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
7399a cons cell which is its own cdr.
7400
a933dad1
DL
7401** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
7402
7403If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
7404#N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
7405
a933dad1
DL
7406** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
7407t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
7408specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
7409is too short to reach that column.
7410
a933dad1
DL
7411** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
7412now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
7413after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
7414two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
7415
7416If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
7417perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
7418and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
7419
a933dad1
DL
7420** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
7421to specify which buffer to return the size of.
7422
a933dad1
DL
7423** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
7424calendar-move-hook after moving point.
7425
a933dad1
DL
7426** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
7427directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
7428small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
7429small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
7430temporary-file-directory instead.
7431
a933dad1
DL
7432** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
7433the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
7434`before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
7435hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
7436
2018166d
DL
7437** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
7438elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
a933dad1 7439
a933dad1
DL
7440** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
7441
7442make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
7443creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
7444ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
7445
a933dad1
DL
7446** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
7447
7448The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
7449on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
7450is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
7451never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
7452ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
7453overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
7454
7455If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
7456that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
7457to get an error if the file exists at that time.
7458The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
7459
a933dad1
DL
7460** Function `format' now handles text properties.
7461
7462Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
7463If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
7464ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
7465result string.
7466
7467Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
7468string where arguments appear in the result string.
7469
7470Example:
7471
7472 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
7473 (s2 "world"))
7474 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
7475 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
b246b1f6 7476 (format s1 s2))
a933dad1
DL
7477
7478results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
7479
a933dad1
DL
7480** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
7481
7482Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
7483The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
7484argument in it.
7485
7486 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
7487 (arg "world"))
7488 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
7489 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
7490 (message msg arg))
7491
a933dad1
DL
7492** Sound support
7493
7494Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
7495(Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
7496
7497Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
7498(*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
7499to enable sound support.
7500
7501Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
7502list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
7503when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
7504functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
7505sound to play, before playing the sound.
7506
7507The following sound properties are supported:
7508
7509- `:file FILE'
7510
7511FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
7512searched relative to `data-directory'.
7513
6fb40beb
GM
7514- `:data DATA'
7515
7516DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
7517may be present, but not both.
7518
a933dad1
DL
7519- `:volume VOLUME'
7520
7521VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
75220..1. This property is optional.
7523
01242779
DL
7524- `:device DEVICE'
7525
7526DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
7527sound. The default device is system-dependent.
7528
a933dad1
DL
7529Other properties are ignored.
7530
01242779
DL
7531An alternative interface is called as
7532(play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
7533
a933dad1 7534** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
356673d4
DL
7535
7536** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
7537a keyword symbol.
fc91dc2d
GM
7538
7539** Changes to garbage collection
7540
7541*** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
7542of live and free strings.
7543
7544*** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
7545strings that have been consed so far.
7546
05197f40 7547\f
04545643
GM
7548* Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
7549Lisp Manual
7550
a299a6f0
GM
7551** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
7552mini-windows.
7553
26fcde61
MB
7554** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
7555argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
7556returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
ea4c1b7c 7557
a299a6f0 7558** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
82a452c8 7559
9a8d84ca 7560** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
2c69ced2
GM
7561
7562** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
7563image.
7564
7565- Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
7566
7567Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
7568
7569SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
7570measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
7571character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
7572font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
7573FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
7574
ebb8f116
GM
7575** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
7576has a mask bitmap.
7577
7578- Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
7579
7580Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
7581FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
7582or omitted means use the selected frame.
7583
0b8a3a6d
DL
7584** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
7585satisfying one of a list of specifications.
7586
0b8a3a6d
DL
7587** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
7588optional.
7589
f6499c03
DL
7590** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
7591below).
04545643 7592
05197f40 7593\f
a933dad1
DL
7594* New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
7595
f6d3257b
GM
7596** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
7597to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
7598
7599Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
7600text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
7601is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
7602your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
7603laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
7604just display it black instead.
7605
7606This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
7607a line like
7608
7609 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
7610
7611in your `.emacs'.
7612
a933dad1
DL
7613** New face implementation.
7614
7615Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
7616font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
7617
a933dad1
DL
7618*** New faces.
7619
7620Each face can specify the following display attributes:
7621
7622 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
79214ddf 7623
a933dad1
DL
7624 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
7625 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
79214ddf 7626
a933dad1 7627 3. Font height in 1/10pt
79214ddf 7628
a933dad1 7629 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
79214ddf 7630
a933dad1 7631 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
79214ddf 7632
a933dad1 7633 6. Foreground color.
79214ddf 7634
a933dad1
DL
7635 7. Background color.
7636
7637 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
7638
7639 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
7640
7641 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
7642
7643 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
7644
7645 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
7646 color.
7647
7648 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
7649 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
7650
7651Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
7652same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
7653frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
7654faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
0969bd6a 7655with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
a933dad1
DL
7656attributes mentioned above.
7657
7658There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
7659definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
7660created frames.
79214ddf 7661
a933dad1
DL
7662A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
7663have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
7664`fully-specified'.
7665
a933dad1
DL
7666*** Face merging.
7667
7668The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
7669combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
7670aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
7671properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
7672that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
7673results in a fully-specified face.
7674
a933dad1
DL
7675*** Face realization.
7676
7677After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
7678merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
7679realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
7680available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
7681face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
7682cache of the frame on which it was realized.
7683
7684Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
7685character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
7686for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
7687charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
7688
7689Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
7690specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
7691being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
7692the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
7693statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
7694
7695In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
7696`char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
76970x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
7698the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
7699initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
7700Emacs.
7701
7702Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
7703`enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
7704registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
7705with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
7706
a933dad1
DL
7707**** Clearing face caches.
7708
7709The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
7710on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
7711unused fonts.
7712
a933dad1 7713*** Font selection.
79214ddf 7714
a933dad1
DL
7715Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
7716given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
7717for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
7718
7719If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
7720pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
7721family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
7722property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
7723an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
7724
7725Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
7726against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
7727match for the given face attributes in this font list.
7728
7729Font selection can be influenced by the user.
7730
7731The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
7732attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
7733face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
7734names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
7735that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
7736width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
7737to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
7738
52d89894
GM
7739Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
7740alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
89d57763 7741doesn't exist.
af4bb4c8
KH
7742
7743Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8a33023e 7744all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
af4bb4c8
KH
7745registry.
7746
8a33023e 7747Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
af4bb4c8
KH
7748slightly different.
7749
7750Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
7751
a933dad1 7752
a933dad1
DL
7753**** Scalable fonts
7754
7755Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
7756since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
7757servers.
7758
7759To enable scalable font use, set the variable
b246b1f6 7760`scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
a933dad1
DL
7761scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
7762Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
7763scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
7764that list. Example:
7765
7766 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
7767
7768allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
7769
a933dad1
DL
7770*** Functions and variables related to font selection.
7771
7772- Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
7773
7774Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
7775is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
7776string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
7777
7778If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
7779the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
7780FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
7781POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
7782SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
7783These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
7784if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
7785REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
7786the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
7787of the face font sort order.
7788
79214ddf 7789- Function: x-font-family-list
a933dad1
DL
7790
7791Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
7792omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
7793(FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
7794non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
7795
7796- Variable: font-list-limit
7797
7798Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
7799won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
7800matching font. The default is currently 100.
7801
a933dad1
DL
7802*** Setting face attributes.
7803
7804For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
7805with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
7806implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
7807`face-attribute'.
7808
7809Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
7810symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
7811
7812The following attributes are recognized:
7813
7814`:family'
7815
7816VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
7817or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
7818and `?' are allowed.
7819
7820`:width'
7821
7822VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
7823It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
7824`condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
7825`extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
7826
7827`:height'
7828
787345ff
MB
7829VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
7830in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
7831scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
7832height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
a933dad1
DL
7833
7834`:weight'
7835
7836VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
7837symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
7838`semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
7839
7840`:slant'
7841
7842VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
7843symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
7844`reverse-oblique'.
7845
7846`:foreground', `:background'
7847
7848VALUE must be a color name, a string.
7849
7850`:underline'
7851
7852VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
7853VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
7854a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
7855don't underline.
7856
7857`:overline'
7858
7859VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
7860VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
7861string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
7862overline.
7863
7864`:strike-through'
7865
7866VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
7867striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
7868face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
7869is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
7870
7871`:box'
7872
7873VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
7874around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
7875VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
7876of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
7877and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
7878VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
7879:color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
7880the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
7881specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
7882defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
7883the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
7884color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
7885should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
7886like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
7887that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
7888the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
7889box.
7890
7891`:inverse-video'
7892
7893VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
7894inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
7895
7896`:stipple'
7897
7898If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
7899The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
7900searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
7901HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
7902is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
7903explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
7904
7905For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
7906and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
7907
7908`:font'
7909
7910Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
7911XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
7912is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
7913versions of Emacs.
7914
7915For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
7916be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
7917must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
7918
7919Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
7920`defface'.
7921
787345ff
MB
7922`:inherit'
7923
7924VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
7925of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
7926like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
7927
a933dad1
DL
7928*** Face attributes and X resources
7929
7930The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
7931from X resources:
7932
7933 Face attribute X resource class
7934-----------------------------------------------------------------------
7935 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
7936 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
7937 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
7938 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
7939 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
7940 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
7941 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
7942 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
7943 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
7944 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
7945 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
7946 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
7947 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
79214ddf 7948 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
a933dad1
DL
7949 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
7950 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
7951 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
7952 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
7953 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
7954
a933dad1
DL
7955*** Text property `face'.
7956
7957The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
7958specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
7959specification can be
7960
79611. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
7962
79632. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
7964 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
7965 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
7966 for face attribute names.
7967
79683. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
7969 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
7970 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
7971
a933dad1
DL
7972** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
7973
acf3ecb7
EZ
7974The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
7975on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
7976the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
a933dad1 7977default. You can get defined colors with a call to
acf3ecb7 7978`defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
a933dad1
DL
7979used to clear the mapping table.
7980
acf3ecb7
EZ
7981** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
7982
7983The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
7984and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
7985type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
7986color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
7987display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
7988old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
7989`x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
7990compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
7991should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
7992modify their color-related behavior.
7993
7994The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
7995any frame type.
7996
8a5719f0
EZ
7997** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
7998
7999The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8000`display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8001`display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8002`display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8003`display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8004`display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8005display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8006the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8007platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8008
27009a49
EZ
8009The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8010display can display image files.
8011
a933dad1 8012** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
a933dad1 8013
463cac2d 8014This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
3b51cca0
MB
8015To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8016the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8017`Inviolable' option.
a933dad1 8018
d586cf1e 8019The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
a933dad1 8020end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
d586cf1e 8021Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
a933dad1 8022
463cac2d
GM
8023** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8024
8025There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8026buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
59927f88 8027property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
463cac2d 8028
9a9dfda8 8029Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
463cac2d 8030forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9a9dfda8 8031to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
463cac2d 8032not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
fc7ac24f
GM
8033commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8034boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8035`inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8036functions.
463cac2d
GM
8037
8038Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9a9dfda8 8039a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
463cac2d 8040editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
a933dad1 8041
9a9dfda8
GM
8042The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8043
59927f88 8044- Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9a9dfda8
GM
8045
8046Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
59927f88 8047
9a9dfda8
GM
8048A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8049If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9b2a085d 8050constrained position if that is different.
9a9dfda8
GM
8051
8052If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8053positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8054ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
59927f88 8055constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9a9dfda8
GM
8056as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8057is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
59927f88
MB
8058fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8059the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8060also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9a9dfda8
GM
8061
8062If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8063NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8064unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8065C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8066only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8067
59927f88
MB
8068If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8069a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8070
8071Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8072
8073- Function: delete-field &optional POS
9a9dfda8 8074
59927f88 8075Delete the field surrounding POS.
9a9dfda8 8076A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8077If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8
GM
8078
8079- Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8080
8081Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8082A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88
MB
8083If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8084If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9a9dfda8
GM
8085field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8086
8087- Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8088
8089Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8090A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88
MB
8091If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8092If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9a9dfda8
GM
8093then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8094
8095- Function: field-string &optional POS
8096
8097Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8098A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8099If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8
GM
8100
8101- Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8102
8103Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8104A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8105If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8 8106
a933dad1
DL
8107** Image support.
8108
8109Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8110strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8111(AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8112replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8113
8114If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8115`(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8116AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
8117window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
8118area.
8119
8120IMAGE is an image specification.
8121
8122*** Image specifications
8123
8124Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
8125is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
8126specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
35a5514b
GM
8127symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
8128described below are ignored.
a933dad1
DL
8129
8130The following is a list of properties all image types share.
8131
8132`:ascent ASCENT'
8133
576da55d
GM
8134ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
8135If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
5d94f558 8136to use for its ascent.
576da55d
GM
8137
8138If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
8139image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
8140
5d94f558 8141If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
04545643
GM
8142centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
8143of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
8144overlays that apply to the image.
a933dad1
DL
8145
8146`:margin MARGIN'
8147
b30623be
GM
8148MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
8149as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
8150horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
a933dad1
DL
8151
8152`:relief RELIEF'
8153
8154RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
8155around an image.
8156
f864120f 8157`:conversion ALGO'
a933dad1 8158
47e351a3
GM
8159Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
8160
8161ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
8162edge-detection algorithm to the image.
8163
8164ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
8165apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
8166nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
8167position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
8168around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
8169neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
8170transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
8171x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
8172below.
8173
8174 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
8175 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
8176 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
8177
8178The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
8179resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
8180multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
8181of the factors' absolute values.
8182
327652be 8183Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
a933dad1 8184
47e351a3
GM
8185 (1 0 0
8186 0 0 0
8187 9 9 -1)
8188
8189Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
8190
8191 ( 2 -1 0
8192 -1 0 1
8193 0 1 -2)
8194
ba9eeda1
GM
8195ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
8196``disabled''.
8197
47e351a3
GM
8198`:mask MASK'
8199
8200If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
8201the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
8202image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
8203background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
8a33023e 8204image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
47e351a3
GM
8205the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
8206GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
8207image.
a933dad1 8208
47e351a3
GM
8209If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
8210in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
8211`:mask nil'.
a933dad1
DL
8212
8213`:file FILE'
8214
8215Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
8216search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
8217building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
8218may be present in the image specification.
8219
518df5c4
GM
8220`:data DATA'
8221
8222Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
8223supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
8224present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
8225support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
8226
a933dad1
DL
8227*** Supported image types
8228
b246b1f6 8229**** XBM, image type `xbm'.
a933dad1
DL
8230
8231XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
0e467b97 8232properties supported are:
a933dad1
DL
8233
8234`:foreground FG'
8235
94736c7c 8236FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
0e467b97 8237meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
a933dad1 8238
46c5af7f 8239`:background BG'
a933dad1 8240
0e467b97 8241BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
94736c7c 8242meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
a933dad1
DL
8243
8244XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
8245case, the image specification must contain the following properties
8246instead of a `:file' property.
8247
8248`:width WIDTH'
8249
8250WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
8251
8252`:height HEIGHT'
8253
8254HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
8255
8256`:data DATA'
8257
8258DATA must be either
8259
8260 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
8261 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
8262
8263 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
8264
8265 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
8266 bitmap.
8267
c76e04a8
GM
8268 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
8269 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
8270 in the file.
8271
a933dad1
DL
8272**** XPM, image type `xpm'
8273
8274XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
8275`xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
8276found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
8277`--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
8278
8279Additional image properties supported are:
8280
8281`:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
8282
8283SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
8284name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
8285name.
8286
8287XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
8288add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
8289
a933dad1
DL
8290The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
8291to display compressed images.
8292
8293**** PBM, image type `pbm'
8294
8295PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
2b8e9c91 8296mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
0e467b97 8297mono images are:
2b8e9c91
GM
8298
8299`:foreground FG'
8300
94736c7c 8301FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
0e467b97 8302meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
2b8e9c91
GM
8303
8304`:background FG'
8305
0e467b97 8306BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
94736c7c 8307meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
a933dad1
DL
8308
8309**** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
8310
8311Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
0e467b97
JB
8312package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8313properties defined.
3bd37feb 8314
a933dad1
DL
8315**** TIFF, image type `tiff'
8316
8317Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
8318package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8319properties defined.
8320
8321**** GIF, image type `gif'
8322
8323Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
8324`libungif-4.1.0', or later.
8325
8326Additional image properties supported are:
8327
8328`:index INDEX'
8329
8330INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
ca205aa3
RS
8331multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
8332as a hollow box.
a933dad1
DL
8333
8334This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
8335For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
8336at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
8337every 0.1 seconds.
8338
8339(defun show-anim (file max)
8340 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
8341 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
8342
8343(defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
8344 (when (= idx max)
8345 (setq idx 0))
518df5c4 8346 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
a933dad1
DL
8347 (save-excursion
8348 (set-buffer buffer)
8349 (goto-char (point-min))
8350 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
8351 (insert-image img "x"))
8352 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
8353
8354**** PNG, image type `png'
8355
8356Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
8357package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8358properties defined.
8359
8360**** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
8361
8362Additional image properties supported are:
8363
8364`:pt-width WIDTH'
8365
8366WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
b246b1f6 8367integer. This is a required property.
a933dad1
DL
8368
8369`:pt-height HEIGHT'
8370
8371HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
b246b1f6 8372must be a integer. This is an required property.
a933dad1
DL
8373
8374`:bounding-box BOX'
8375
8376BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
8377the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
8378files. This is an required property.
8379
8380Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
8381lisp/gs.el.
8382
8383*** Lisp interface.
8384
79214ddf
FP
8385The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
8386which are supported in the current configuration.
a933dad1
DL
8387
8388Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
8389they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
8390The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
084cec2f
GM
8391manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
8392images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
a933dad1
DL
8393
8394*** Simplified image API, image.el
8395
8396The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
8397creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
8398can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
8399define an image based on available image types. The functions
8400`put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
8401buffer.
8402
a933dad1
DL
8403** Display margins.
8404
8405Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
8406and images.
8407
8408To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
8409`left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
8410`set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
8411obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
8412`right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
8413the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
8414of the display margins.
8415
8416You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
8417containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
8418one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
8419string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
8420in this file).
8421
a933dad1
DL
8422** Help display
8423
8424Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
8425moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
8426`help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
8427that have a `help-echo' property.
8428
9662da0b 8429If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
85a8aca9 8430is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
c20aeb83
GM
8431the window in which the help was found.
8432
8433If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
8434`help-echo' text property was found.
8435
8436If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
8437POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
8438
8439If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
5ed8d5af 8440the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
c20aeb83 8441mouse.
d5aa31d8 8442
9662da0b
GM
8443If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
8444string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
8445
8446For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
8447determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
8448property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
8449For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
8450used as help string.
a933dad1
DL
8451
8452The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
f0298744
DL
8453the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
8454causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
a933dad1 8455
a933dad1
DL
8456** Vertical fractional scrolling.
8457
8458The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
8459This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
8460
8461The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
8462scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
8463The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
8464scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
8465used.
8466
79214ddf
FP
8467 (global-set-key [A-down]
8468 #'(lambda ()
a933dad1 8469 (interactive)
79214ddf 8470 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
a933dad1 8471 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
79214ddf 8472 (global-set-key [A-up]
a933dad1
DL
8473 #'(lambda ()
8474 (interactive)
79214ddf 8475 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
a933dad1
DL
8476 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
8477
a933dad1
DL
8478** New hook `fontification-functions'.
8479
8480Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
8481when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
8482variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
8483is called with one argument, POS.
8484
8485At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
8486characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
8487as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
8488property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
8489`fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
8490
a933dad1
DL
8491** Tool bar support.
8492
8493Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
8494parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
8495controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
8496suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
8497`auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
8498automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
8499
8500*** Tool bar item definitions
8501
8502Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
8503`tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
8504where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
79214ddf 8505
a933dad1
DL
8506CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
8507evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
8508the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
8509property (see below).
79214ddf 8510
a933dad1
DL
8511BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
8512binding are currently ignored.
8513
8514The following properties are recognized:
8515
8516`:enable FORM'.
79214ddf 8517
a933dad1
DL
8518FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
8519or disabled.
79214ddf 8520
a933dad1 8521`:visible FORM'
79214ddf 8522
a933dad1 8523FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
79214ddf 8524
a933dad1
DL
8525`:filter FUNCTION'
8526
8527FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
8528FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
8529used instead of BINDING to display this item.
79214ddf 8530
a933dad1
DL
8531`:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
8532
8533TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
8534and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
79214ddf 8535
a933dad1
DL
8536`:image IMAGES'
8537
8538IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
8539image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
8540meaning of each of the four elements:
8541
8542 Index Use when item is
8543 ----------------------------------------
8544 0 enabled and selected
8545 1 enabled and deselected
8546 2 disabled and selected
8547 3 disabled and deselected
79214ddf 8548
4ba7246d
GM
8549If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
8550algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
8551
a933dad1 8552`:help HELP-STRING'.
79214ddf 8553
a933dad1
DL
8554Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
8555is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
8556
dab96841 8557The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
d1e68bce
DL
8558toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
8559to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
8560menu bar.
dab96841 8561
8628686a
DL
8562The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
8563dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
8564buffer-locally to override the global map.
8565
a933dad1
DL
8566*** Tool-bar-related variables.
8567
8568If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
8569resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
8570than 1/4 of the frame's size.
8571
79214ddf 8572If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
a933dad1
DL
8573raised when the mouse moves over them.
8574
8575You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
8576`tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
b30623be
GM
8577pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
8578vertical margins . Default is 1.
a933dad1
DL
8579
8580You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
8581`tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
8582
8583*** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
8584
8585You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
79214ddf 8586a tool bar item. If
a933dad1
DL
8587
8588 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
8589 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
8590 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
8591
8592is the original tool bar item definition, then
8593
8594 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
8595
8596makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
8597item.
8598
8599** Mode line changes.
8600
a933dad1
DL
8601*** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
8602
8603The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
8604that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
8605a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
8606
86071. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
8608a `local-map' text property.
8609
86102. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
8611that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
8612
86133. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
8614is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
8615`local-map' property.
8616
8617The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
8618properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
8619example.
8620
54522c9f
GM
8621*** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
8622evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
8623
a933dad1
DL
8624*** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
8625variable mode-line-format to nil.
8626
a933dad1
DL
8627*** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
8628
8629This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
8630`header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
8631completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
8632`default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
8633line.
8634
8635The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
8636`header-line'.
8637
8638The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
8639position in the header-line.
8640
a933dad1
DL
8641** Text property `display'
8642
623a0aae
GM
8643The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
8644replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
8645also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
8646the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
a933dad1
DL
8647below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
8648
623a0aae
GM
8649*** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
8650
8651To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
8652text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
8653
8654If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
8655marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
8656the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
8657is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8658simpler form STRING as property value.
8659
a933dad1
DL
8660*** Variable width and height spaces
8661
8662To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
8663specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
8664`(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
8665area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
8666marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
8667displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8668simpler form STRETCH as property value.
8669
8670The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
8671PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
8672properties described below.
8673
8674The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
8675characters having the `display' property.
8676
8677- :width WIDTH
8678
8679Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
8680character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
8681
8682- :relative-width FACTOR
8683
8684Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
8685first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
8686same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
8687width of that character by FACTOR.
8688
8689- :align-to HPOS
8690
8691Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
8692value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
8693
8694Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
8695
8696- :height HEIGHT
8697
8698Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
8699normal line height.
8700
8701- :relative-height FACTOR
8702
8703The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
8704of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
8705
8706- :ascent ASCENT
8707
8708Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
8709used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
8710baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
8711equal to 100.
8712
8713You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
8714
8715*** Images
8716
8717A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
8718. IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
8719in the display, the characters having this display specification in
8720their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
8721the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
8722`(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
8723area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
8724the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
8725as display specification.
8726
8727*** Other display properties
8728
c9e73000 8729- (space-width FACTOR)
a933dad1
DL
8730
8731Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
8732should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
8733integer or float.
8734
c9e73000 8735- (height HEIGHT)
a933dad1
DL
8736
8737Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
8738
8739If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
8740means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
8741the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
8742``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
8743a font is available counts as a step.
8744
8745If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
8746as tall as the frame's default font.
8747
8748If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
8749height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
8750
8751Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
8752`height' bound to the current specified font height.
8753
c9e73000 8754- (raise FACTOR)
a933dad1
DL
8755
8756FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
8757font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
8758raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
8759amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
c9e73000 8760`height' subproperty.
a933dad1
DL
8761
8762*** Conditional display properties
8763
8764All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
6c6caea2
GM
8765has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
8766only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
8767evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
8768conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
8769bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
8770the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
8771different when object is a string.
a933dad1
DL
8772
8773The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
6c6caea2 8774`(when t . SPEC)'.
a933dad1 8775
a933dad1
DL
8776** New menu separator types.
8777
8778Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
8779item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
8780treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
8781to specify other menu separator types.
8782
8783- `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
8784
8785No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
8786separator occurs.
8787
8788- `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
8789
8790A single line in the menu's foreground color.
8791
8792- `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
8793
8794A double line in the menu's foreground color.
8795
8796- `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
8797
8798A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
8799
8800- `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
8801
8802A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
8803
8804- `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
8805
f3780fe4 8806A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
a933dad1
DL
8807displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
8808
8809- `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
8810
8811A single line with 3D raised appearance.
8812
8813- `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
8814
8815A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
8816
8817- `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
8818
8819A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
8820
8821- `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
8822
8823Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
8824
8825- `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
8826
8827Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
8828
8829- `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
8830
8831Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
8832
8833- `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
8834
8835Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
8836
8837Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
8838the corresponding single-line separators.
8839
a933dad1
DL
8840** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
8841
8842The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
8843`scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
8844Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
8845that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
8846default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
8847default background is the background color of the frame, and the
8848default foreground is black.
8849
8850The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
8851(class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
8852`ScrollBarBackground').
8853
8854Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
8855settings for scroll bar colors.
8856
a933dad1
DL
8857** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
8858display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
8859
a933dad1
DL
8860** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
8861starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
8862on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
8863line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
8864the original window start.
8865
a933dad1
DL
8866** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
8867`hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
8868now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
8869
a933dad1
DL
8870** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
8871
8872A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
8873`window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
8874windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
8875other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
8876
8877The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
8878fixed-width and fixed-height.
8879
8880 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
8881
8882A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
8883fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
8884window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
8885change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
8886temporarily to nil, for example
8887
8888 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
8889 (enlarge-window 10))
8890
79214ddf 8891Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
a933dad1 8892or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
e411ce4b
EZ
8893
8894** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
8895terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
8896to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
8897overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
8898horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
8899support a vertical-bar cursor).
76299050 8900
3787e12e 8901
05197f40 8902\f
3787e12e
GM
8903* Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
8904
8905** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
8906input.
8907
8908** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
8909
8910** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
8911
8912** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
8913only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
8914exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
8915(e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
8916(e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
8917
8918** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
8919been added.
8920
05197f40 8921\f
3787e12e
GM
8922* Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
8923
8924** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
8925
0cb146bf 8926
05197f40 8927\f
3787e12e
GM
8928* Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
8929
8930** Not new, but not mentioned before:
8931M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
05197f40 8932\f
3787e12e
GM
8933* Changes in Emacs 20.4
8934
8935** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
8936
8937You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
8938Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
8939`.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
8940
8941If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
8942is the one that is used.
8943
8944** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
8945the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
8946Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
8947separate from the command's regular output.
8948Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
8949says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
8950In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
8951the buffer name.
8952
8953When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
8954output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
8955it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
8956cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
8957
8958** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
8959the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
8960is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
8961created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
8962
8963** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
8964example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
8965match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
8966quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
8967
8968** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
8969now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
8970if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
8971they never ignore case.
8972
8973** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
8974under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
8975applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
8976of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
8977just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
8978convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
8979part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
8980
8981If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
8982the same format that was used in the file before.
8983
8984You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
8985`inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
8986
8987** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
8988renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
8989This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
8990
8991** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
8992The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
8993buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
8994your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
8995is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
8996end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
8997Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
8998
8999The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9000eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9001control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9002format. You can now customize these variables.
9003
9004** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9005filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9006filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9007enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9008
9009** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9010in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9011windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9012
9013** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9014dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9015doesn't have any effect.
9016
9017** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9018not one per buffer.
9019
9020** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9021use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9022 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9023
9024** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9025To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9026`auto-show-mode' command.
9027
9028** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9029avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9030versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9031choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9032occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9033
9034** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9035cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9036
9037** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9038character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9039feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9040
9041** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9042the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9043interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9044and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9045
9046** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9047
9048The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9049that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9050one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9051codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9052set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9053
9054Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9055from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9056
9057IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9058equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9059a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9060`?' on other systems.
9061
9062IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9063feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9064Unix.
9065
9066Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9067current codepage when it starts.
9068
9069** Mail changes
9070
9071*** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9072`mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9073appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9074non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9075MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9076headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9077latin-1:
9078
9079 MIME-version: 1.0
9080 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9081 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9082
9083*** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9084default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9085default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9086sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9087buffer-file-coding-system.
9088
9089You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9090sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9091mail.
9092
9093*** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9094if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9095Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9096list of possible coding systems.
9097
9098** CC Mode changes
9099
9100*** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9101modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9102longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9103docstring for details.
9104
9105*** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9106symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9107found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9108prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9109lineup functions use this feature currently.
9110
9111*** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9112"finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9113
9114*** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9115"catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9116
9117*** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
9118from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
9119symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
9120c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
9121anonymous classes.
9122
9123*** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
9124syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
9125
9126*** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
9127inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
9128support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
9129function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
9130
9131*** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
9132(i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
9133brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
9134c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
9135(brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
9136
9137*** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
9138
9139*** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
9140
9141*** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
9142for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
9143
9144*** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
9145
9146*** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
9147associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
9148This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
9149circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
9150class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
9151
9152** Gnus changes.
9153
9154*** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
9155added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
9156Gnus manual for the full story.
9157
9158*** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
9159before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
9160group, which is created automatically.
9161
9162*** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
9163values.
9164
9165*** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
9166
9167*** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
9168outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
9169
9170*** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
9171`C-u C-c C-c'.
9172
9173*** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
9174
9175*** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
9176re-highlighting of the article buffer.
9177
9178*** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
9179
9180*** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
9181Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
9182
9183*** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
9184`a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
9185
9186*** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
9187control over simplification.
9188
9189*** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
9190
9191*** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
9192limit.
9193
9194*** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
9195
9196*** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
9197
9198*** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
9199If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
9200rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
9201
8a33023e 9202*** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
3787e12e
GM
9203`a' forces normal posting method.
9204
9205*** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
9206-- `W d'.
9207
9208*** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
9209to a non-nil value.
9210
9211*** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
9212where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
9213
9214*** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
9215has been added.
9216
9217*** A history of where mails have been split is available.
9218
9219*** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
9220
9221*** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
9222`gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
9223
9224*** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
9225`message-cite-original-without-signature'.
9226
9227*** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
9228
9229*** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
9230been added.
9231
9232*** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
9233`gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
9234
9235*** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
9236updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
9237
9238*** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
9239
9240*** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
9241
9242*** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
9243
9244** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
9245
9246*** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
9247options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
9248nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
9249
9250*** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
9251TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
9252of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
9253TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
9254can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
9255
9256*** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
9257All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
9258but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
9259the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
9260
9261*** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
9262the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
9263buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
9264mismatch.
9265
9266** Changes to RefTeX mode
9267
9268*** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
9269file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
9270
9271*** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
9272lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
9273characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
9274removed from the label.
9275
9276*** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
9277a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
9278
9279*** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
9280customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
9281
9282*** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
9283`reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
9284expressions.
9285
9286*** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
9287
9288** New/deleted modes and packages
9289
9290*** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
9291SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
9292
9293*** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
9294editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
9295SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
9296
9297*** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
9298changes with a special face.
9299
9300*** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
9301this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
9302Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
05197f40 9303\f
3787e12e
GM
9304* MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
9305
9306** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
9307This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
9308conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
9309and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
9310check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
9311
9312The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
9313Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
9314distribution when the config.bat script is run.
9315
9316** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
9317MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
9318controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
9319directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
9320Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
9321on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
9322string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
9323program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
9324printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
9325
9326** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
9327output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
9328available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
9329input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
9330temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
9331program.
9332
9333An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
9334and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
9335programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
9336automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
9337as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
9338ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
9339
9340** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
9341a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
9342MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
9343was not documented clearly before.
9344
9345** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
9346This includes Tetris and Snake.
05197f40 9347\f
3787e12e
GM
9348* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
9349
9350** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
9351return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
9352They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
9353meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
9354
9355** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
9356WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
9357and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
9358
9359** Changes in the file-attributes function.
9360
9361*** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
9362It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
9363
9364*** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
9365the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
9366integers.
9367
9368** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
9369files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
9370arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
9371file names and attributes are returned.
9372
9373** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
9374sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
8a33023e 9375accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
3787e12e
GM
9376It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
9377returns the result.
9378
9379** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
9380to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
9381
9382** New functions for base64 conversion:
9383
9384The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
9385into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
9386performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
9387optionally.
9388
9389Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
9390job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
9391
9392**
9393The new function process-running-child-p
9394will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
9395terminal to its own child process.
9396
9397** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
9398when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
9399to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
9400itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
9401
9402** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
9403be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
9404
4a389f53 9405** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
3787e12e
GM
9406:included is an alias for :visible.
9407
9408easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
9409easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
9410to move or copy menu entries.
9411
9412** Multibyte editing changes
9413
9414*** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
9415an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
9416make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
9417work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
9418char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
9419 (setq char (sref str idx)
9420 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
9421The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
9422
9423If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
9424(say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
9425 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
9426
9427*** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
9428region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
9429deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
9430
8a33023e 9431 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
3787e12e
GM
9432
9433This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
9434across the boundary.
9435
9436*** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
9437`unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
9438 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
9439 contains 8-bit characters.
9440 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
9441 contains invalid characters.
9442
9443*** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
9444text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
9445preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
9446text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
9447way.
9448
9449*** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
9450If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
9451end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
9452prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
9453
9454*** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
9455compose Thai characters in a string.
9456
9457** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
9458argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
9459for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
9460menus should always use the third argument.
9461
9462** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
9463read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
9464arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
9465input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
9466
9467** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
9468of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
9469programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
9470inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
9471
9472** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
9473the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
9474returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
9475echo area contents.
9476
9477 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
9478
9479** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
9480NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
9481requested feature cannot be loaded.
9482
9483** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
9484foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
9485means to clear out that attribute.
9486
9487** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
9488gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
9489
9490** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
9491read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
9492unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
9493end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
9494
9495** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
9496the gap of the current buffer.
9497
9498** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
9499to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
9500current buffer.
9501
9502** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
9503facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
9504These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
9505it back in after any modifications have been made.
05197f40 9506\f
3787e12e
GM
9507* Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
9508
9509** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
9510the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
9511/usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
9512directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
9513subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
9514
9515Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
9516names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
9517Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
9518which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
9519these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
9520
9521Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
9522starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
9523time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
9524
9525This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
9526Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
9527to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
9528subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
9529`.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
9530results.
9531
9532** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
9533GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
9534that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
9535fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
05197f40 9536\f
3787e12e
GM
9537* Changes in Emacs 20.3
9538
9539** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
9540including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
9541it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
9542perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
9543
9544** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
9545specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
9546region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
9547further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
9548command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
9549within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
9550are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
9551region.
9552
9553In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
9554selective undo.
9555
9556** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
9557unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
9558buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
9559effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
9560Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
9561
9562The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
9563though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
9564-*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
9565load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
9566
9567** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
9568no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
9569enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
9570something that most users not do.
9571
9572** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
9573operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
9574The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
9575applications.
9576
9577C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
9578pasting operations.
9579
9580** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
9581setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
9582like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
9583printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
9584`ps-printer-name'.
9585
9586** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
9587minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
9588any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
9589except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
9590incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
9591hits a new word.
9592
9593Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
9594Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
9595to be confused by TeX commands.
9596
9597You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
9598correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
9599clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
9600of various alternative replacements and actions.
9601
9602Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
9603the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
9604corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
9605alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
9606flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
9607
9608Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
9609flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
9610
9611** Changes in input method usage.
9612
9613Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
9614the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
9615respectively.
9616
9617You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
9618
9619If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
9620of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
9621
9622The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
9623that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
9624
9625 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
9626
9627 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
9628
9629 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
9630 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
9631
9632 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
9633 given in the following case:
9634 o When you are using a complex input method.
9635 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
9636
9637If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
9638input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
9639and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
9640setting it to t is helpful.
9641
9642The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
9643
9644In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
9645keys:
9646 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
9647 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
9648 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
9649These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
9650environment.
9651
9652** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
9653names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
9654minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
9655get
9656
9657 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
9658
9659which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
9660
9661Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
9662Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
9663
9664** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
9665at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
9666its owner and group.
9667
9668** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
9669Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
9670
9671** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
9672contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
9673
9674** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
9675which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
9676in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
9677by the left edge of the rectangle.
9678
9679** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
9680increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
9681C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
9682for writing keyboard macros.
9683
9684** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
9685files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
9686frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
9687the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
9688additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
9689info.
9690
9691** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
9692
9693** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
9694query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
9695contents only.
9696
9697** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
9698confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
9699the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
9700says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
9701
9702** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
9703non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
9704literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
9705
9706** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
9707now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
9708Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
9709inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
9710
9711** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
9712failure if the command produces no output.
9713
9714** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
9715manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
9716the mouse.
9717
9718** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
9719mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
9720function and variable names.
9721
9722** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
9723reading specific files. This has higher priority than
9724file-coding-system-alist.
9725
9726** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
9727t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
9728converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
9729the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
9730according to the current fontset.
9731
9732** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
9733
9734The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
9735that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
9736nonascii-insert-offset.
9737
9738For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
9739enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
9740nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
9741characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
9742
9743** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
9744an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
9745
9746** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
9747letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
9748
9749** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
9750are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
9751command keys.
9752
9753** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
9754user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
9755
9756Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
9757user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
9758all variables that have documentation.
9759
9760** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
9761shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
9762that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
9763minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
9764it should show; the default is 20.
9765
9766Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
9767the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
9768of your input.
9769
9770** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
9771all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
9772recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
9773argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
9774the customizable options which were changed since that version.
9775Newly added options are included as well.
9776
9777If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
9778then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
9779for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
9780
9781This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
9782Customize menu.
9783
9784** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
9785the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
9786
9787** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
9788buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
9789invoked.
9790
9791** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
9792that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
9793The default is 1.
9794
9795** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
9796syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
9797new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
9798(C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
9799sensibly.
9800
9801** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
9802
9803** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
9804value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
9805two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
9806
9807** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
9808reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
9809for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
9810every night.
9811
9812** Desktop changes
9813
9814*** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
9815the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
9816
9817*** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
9818and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
9819
9820** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
9821read and post multi-lingual articles.
9822
9823** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
9824doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
9825be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
9826outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
9827the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
9828made invisible again.
9829
9830** Mail reading and sending changes
9831
9832*** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
9833the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
9834changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
9835toggle.
9836
9837*** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
9838now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
9839summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
9840the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
9841rmail-default-body-file.
9842
9843*** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
9844longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
9845handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
9846
9847*** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
9848it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
9849is evaluated to insert the signature.
9850
9851*** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
9852outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
9853handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
9854putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
9855transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
9856especially interested in trying feedmail.
9857
9858feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
9859feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
9860provided by feedmail are:
9861
9862**** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
9863stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
9864there is also a queue for draft messages
9865
9866**** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
9867be prompted for confirmation
9868
9869**** does smart filling of address headers
9870
9871**** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
9872the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
9873can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
9874
9875**** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
9876the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
9877/usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
9878function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
9879
9880** Dired changes
9881
9882*** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
9883files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
9884
9885*** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
9886run Dired on the directory name at point.
9887
9888*** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
9889files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
9890for a specified regexp.
9891
9892** VC Changes
9893
9894*** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
9895conveniently.
9896
9897*** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
9898faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
9899Dired.
9900
9901VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
9902directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
9903listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
9904currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
9905
9906You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
9907then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
9908vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
9909control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
9910on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
9911
9912All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
9913is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
9914`v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
9915the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
9916`vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
9917
9918The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
9919toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
9920VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
9921`* l', to mark all files currently locked.
9922
9923Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
9924ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
9925command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
9926
9927*** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
9928file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
9929session to resolve them.
9930
9931Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
9932resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
9933contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
9934uses as well).
9935
9936*** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
9937command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
9938you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
9939either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
9940branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
9941If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
9942using ediff.
9943
9944** Changes in Font Lock
9945
9946*** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
9947are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
9948use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
9949unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
9950compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
9951
9952** Frame name display changes
9953
9954*** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
9955frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
9956raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
9957when many frames are invisible or iconified.
9958
9959*** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
9960frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
9961menu.
9962
9963** Comint (subshell) changes
9964
9965*** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
9966subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
9967with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
9968
9969*** There are new commands in Comint mode.
9970
9971C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
9972that is, the line after the last line you got.
9973You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
9974
9975C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
9976send the current line together with the following line, when you send
9977the following line.
9978
9979C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
9980which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
9981previously sent input.
9982
9983C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
9984it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
9985as the search string.
9986
9987*** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
9988automatically in compilation-mode windows.
9989
9990** C mode changes
9991
9992*** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
9993and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
9994assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
9995definition.
9996
9997*** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
9998(i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
9999Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10000style is still the default however.
10001
10002*** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10003
10004*** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10005are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10006them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10007
10008*** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10009and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10010
10011*** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10012namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10013
10014*** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10015makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10016
10017*** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10018c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10019
10020*** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10021should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10022package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10023variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10024
10025** Changes to hippie-expand.
10026
10027*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10028non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10029which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10030
10031*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10032non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10033expanding dynamically.
10034
10035*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10036non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10037
10038*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10039non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10040this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10041expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10042
10043*** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10044
10045** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10046
10047*** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10048bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10049automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10050bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10051against the first word in the title.
10052
10053*** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10054capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10055bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10056lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10057lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10058bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10059
10060*** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10061generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10062replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10063bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10064
10065** Changes in vcursor.el.
10066
10067*** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10068and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10069variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10070entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10071`vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10072in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10073
10074*** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10075Editing group once the package is loaded.
10076
10077*** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10078generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
8a33023e 10079vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
3787e12e
GM
10080
10081*** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10082vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10083
10084** Ispell changes.
10085
10086*** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10087buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10088are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10089
10090*** Generic region skipping implemented.
10091A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10092and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10093defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10094include:
10095
10096 o URLs are automatically skipped
10097 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10098
10099*** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10100
10101** Changes to RefTeX mode
10102
10103RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10104large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10105re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10106section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10107
10108*** New recursive parser.
10109
10110The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10111entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10112recursive parser scans the individual files.
10113
10114*** Parsing only part of a document.
10115
10116Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
10117partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
10118the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
10119
10120 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
10121
10122*** Storing parsing information in a file.
10123
10124This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
10125
10126 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
10127
10128*** Using multiple selection buffers
10129
10130If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
10131for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
10132
10133 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
10134
10135*** References to external documents.
10136
10137The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
10138documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
10139documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
10140macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
10141RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
10142the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
10143The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
10144
10145*** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
10146
8a33023e 10147The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
3787e12e
GM
10148and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
10149
10150Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
10151the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
10152
10153*** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
10154
10155The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
10156buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
10157
10158*** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
10159
10160The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
10161contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
10162`reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
10163have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
10164enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
10165at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
10166more.
10167
10168*** Support for the varioref package
10169
10170The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
10171
10172*** New hooks
10173
10174Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
10175and citations are created. These hooks are
10176`reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
10177`reftex-format-cite-function'.
10178
10179*** Citations outside LaTeX
10180
10181The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
10182a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
10183
10184*** Short context is no longer fontified.
10185
10186The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
10187fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
10188fontified, use
10189
10190 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
10191
10192** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
10193With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
10194the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
10195directories that contain the same file name.
10196
10197Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
10198Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
10199file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
10200Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
10201have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
10202names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
10203directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
10204directory.
10205
10206** New modes and packages
10207
10208*** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
10209It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
10210it, but some do not.
10211
10212*** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
10213code.
10214
10215*** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
10216current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
10217around in a buffer.
10218
10219Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
10220
10221*** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
10222uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
10223be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
10224established system of notation similar to Chess.
10225
10226*** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
10227documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
10228guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
10229
10230*** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
10231available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
10232system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
10233simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
10234functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
10235the like.
10236
10237*** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
10238identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
10239
10240*** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
10241within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
10242used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
10243the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
10244
10245*** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
10246
10247 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
10248 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
10249 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
10250 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
10251 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
10252 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
10253 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
10254 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
10255 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
10256 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
10257 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
10258
10259 Platform-specific modes:
10260
10261 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
10262 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
10263 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
10264 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
10265 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
10266 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
10267 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
10268 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
10269 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
05197f40 10270\f
3787e12e
GM
10271* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10272
10273** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
10274use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
10275That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
10276Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
10277
10278Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
10279you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
10280consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
10281
10282** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
10283and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
10284specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
10285searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
10286
10287** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
10288multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
10289character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
10290environment.
10291
10292** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
10293take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
10294string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
10295current input method for reading this one event.
10296
10297** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
10298now control whether to output certain characters as
10299backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
10300non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
10301characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
10302in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
05197f40 10303\f
3787e12e
GM
10304* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10305
10306** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
10307of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
10308
10309** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
10310in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
10311always increases point by 1.
10312
10313The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
10314considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
10315
10316See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
10317
10318** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
10319Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
10320default value changed. For example,
10321
10322 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
10323 :type 'integer
10324 :group 'foo
10325 :version "20.3")
10326
10327 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
10328 :version "20.3")
10329
10330If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
10331default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
10332is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
10333`:version' in the top level group.
10334
10335This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
10336
10337** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
10338starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
10339
10340However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
10341symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
10342support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
10343to themselves.
10344
10345If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
10346this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
10347values whatever.
10348
10349** There is a new debugger command, R.
10350It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
10351in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
10352
10353** Frame-local variables.
10354
10355You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
10356the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
10357local bindings for that variable.
10358
10359These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
10360frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
10361modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
10362parameter name.
10363
10364Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
10365Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
10366active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
10367that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
10368
10369It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
10370clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
10371very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
10372through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
10373
10374** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
10375"symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
10376evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
10377makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
10378See the documentation in sregex.el.
10379
10380** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
10381is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
10382parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
10383The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
10384
10385** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
10386If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
10387
10388** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
10389known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
10390define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
10391
10392** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
10393when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
10394it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
10395history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
10396
10397The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
10398return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
10399empty input.
10400
10401** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
10402for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
10403`iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
10404Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
10405`read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
10406
10407** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
10408echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
10409a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
10410default password to use if the user enters nothing.
10411
10412** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
10413specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
10414function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
10415place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
10416non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
10417
10418** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
10419If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
10420up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
10421end of the window, even if this requires computation.
10422
10423** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
10424which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
10425If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
10426
10427** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
10428holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
10429was directed to display this buffer.
10430
10431** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
10432with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
10433describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
10434other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
10435set-window-configuration.
10436
10437** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
10438window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
10439positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
10440windows and the choice of buffers to display.
10441
10442** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
10443override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
10444look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
10445
10446If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
10447non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
10448map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
10449
10450minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
10451and it is meant to be set by major modes.
10452
10453** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
10454except that it discards all text properties from the result.
10455
10456** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
10457USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
10458floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
10459
10460** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
10461to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
10462in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
10463it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
10464
10465** Menu changes
10466
10467*** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
10468keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
10469better supported.
10470
10471The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
10472a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
10473you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
10474can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
10475then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
10476
10477*** A new format for menu items is supported.
10478
10479In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
10480 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
10481defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
10482starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
10483
10484The format is:
10485 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
10486 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
10487where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
10488string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
10489The supported properties include
10490
10491:enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10492 item is enabled.
10493:visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10494 item should appear in the menu.
10495:filter FILTER-FN
10496 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
10497 which will be REAL-BINDING.
10498 It should return a binding to use instead.
10499:keys DESCRIPTION
10500 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
f3780fe4 10501 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
3787e12e
GM
10502 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
10503:key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
10504 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
10505 keyboard binding.
10506:key-sequence nil
10507 This means that the command normally has no
10508 keyboard equivalent.
10509:help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
10510:button (TYPE . SELECTED)
10511 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
10512 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
10513 value says whether this button is currently selected.
10514
10515Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
10516Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
10517
10518(menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
10519
10520** New event types
10521
10522*** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
10523mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
10524corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
10525which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
10526
10527 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
10528
10529where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10530same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
10531indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
10532negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
10533the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
10534forward, away from the user.
10535
10536As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
10537
10538*** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
10539files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
10540and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
10541filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
10542loaded into Emacs. The format is:
10543
10544 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
10545
10546where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10547same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
10548that were dragged and dropped.
10549
10550As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
10551
10552** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
10553
10554*** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
10555any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
10556to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
10557
10558*** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
10559can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
10560that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
10561
10562*** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
10563in Emacs 19 and before.
10564
10565The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
10566The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
10567
10568*** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
10569buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
10570unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
10571representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
10572
10573This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
10574as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
10575viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
10576one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
10577will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
10578
10579This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
10580representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
10581(including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
10582consistent with the new representation.
10583
10584*** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
10585representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
10586about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
10587however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
10588
10589The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
10590nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
10591using the table nonascii-translation-table.
10592
10593*** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
10594representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
10595representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
10596
10597The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
10598loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
10599is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
10600
10601*** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
10602which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
10603
10604*** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
10605which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
10606
10607*** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
10608portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
10609so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
10610You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
10611
10612*** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
10613it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
10614
10615*** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
10616convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
10617buffer or string being searched.
10618
10619One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
10620[...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
10621searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
10622searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
10623obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
10624you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
10625expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
10626
10627*** Structure of coding system changed.
10628
10629All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
10630by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
10631which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
10632as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
10633vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
10634your own alias name of a coding system by the function
10635define-coding-system-alias.
10636
10637The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
10638the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
10639access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
10640pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
10641character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
10642safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
10643'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
10644`iso-8859-1'.
10645
10646Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
10647The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
10648coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
10649(coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
10650
10651Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
10652also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
10653are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
10654the other character sets and read it back correctly.
10655
10656*** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
10657proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
10658This function requires a user interaction.
10659
10660*** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
10661find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
10662select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
10663systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
10664a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
10665select-safe-coding-system.
10666
10667*** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
10668decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
10669last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
10670was done.
10671
10672*** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
10673used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
10674coding systems used by some specific language environment.
10675
10676*** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
10677return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
10678characters are found, they now return a list of single element
10679`undecided' or its subsidiaries.
10680
10681*** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
10682coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
10683coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
10684converted.
10685
10686*** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
10687coding system for communicating with other X clients.
10688
10689*** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
10690character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
10691character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
10692each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
10693either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
10694range of characters.
10695
10696*** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
10697Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
10698
10699*** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
10700in the current buffer at position POS.
10701
10702*** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
10703input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
10704function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
10705character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
10706event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
10707binding input-method-function to nil.
10708
10709The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
10710method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
10711input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
10712the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
10713not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
10714
10715The input method function is not called when reading the second and
10716subsequent events of a key sequence.
10717
10718*** You can customize any language environment by using
10719set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
10720
10721The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
10722customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
10723instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
10724environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
10725exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
05197f40 10726\f
3787e12e
GM
10727* Changes in Emacs 20.1
10728
10729** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
10730options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
10731at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
10732tree structure.
10733
10734M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
10735user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
10736
10737With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
10738session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
10739in your .emacs file.)
10740
10741** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
10742You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
10743
10744** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
10745This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
10746
10747** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
10748immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
10749kills the region.
10750
10751The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
10752delete the character before point, as usual.
10753
10754** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
10755on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
10756by setting search-highlight to nil.)
10757
10758** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
10759insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
10760the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
10761onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
10762history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
10763past.)
10764
10765** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
10766This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
10767in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
10768TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
10769makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
10770
10771As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
10772and is an alias for it.
10773
10774If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
10775use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
10776
10777** Scrolling changes
10778
10779*** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
10780position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
10781
10782In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
10783on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
10784where it started.
10785
10786*** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
10787move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
10788screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
10789does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
10790
10791*** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
10792top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
10793comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
10794recenters the window.
10795
10796** International character set support (MULE)
10797
10798Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
10799including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
10800Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
10801Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
10802features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
10803MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
10804
10805Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
10806coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
10807character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
10808variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
10809into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
10810
10811Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
10812generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
10813supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
10814language, to make it possible to type them.
10815
10816The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
10817character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
10818
10819The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
10820to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
10821
10822You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
10823
10824 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
10825
10826Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
10827characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
10828argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
10829already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
10830characters for their work until they want to change.
10831
10832*** Input methods
10833
10834An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
10835specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
10836has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
10837the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
10838support several input methods.
10839
10840The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
10841another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
10842work.
10843
10844A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
10845characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
10846composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
10847consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
10848sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
10849letter.
10850
10851The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
10852by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
10853First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
10854marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
10855mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
10856
10857None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
10858they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
10859phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
10860converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
10861
10862Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
10863word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
10864typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
10865the first guess is wrong.
10866
10867*** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
10868turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
10869
10870If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
10871byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
10872they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
10873the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
10874
10875However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
10876use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
10877includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
10878translate automatically to and from either one.
10879
10880*** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
10881
10882Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
10883file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
10884sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
10885what you want.
10886
10887If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
10888example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
10889system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
10890multibyte characters in that buffer.
10891
10892If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
10893character conversion as well.
10894
10895*** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
10896
10897A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
10898Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
10899requires using many fonts.
10900
10901Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
10902collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
10903
10904A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
10905the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
10906have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
10907you would use a font.
10908
10909If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
10910specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
10911display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
10912
10913The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
10914(that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
f327c2f9 10915characters).
3787e12e
GM
10916
10917*** Defining fontsets.
10918
10919Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
10920chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
10921with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
10922
10923Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
10924of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
10925`fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
10926standard fontset are created automatically.
10927
10928If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
10929argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
10930FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
10931with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
10932name is `fontset-startup'.
10933
10934Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
10935The resource value should have this form:
10936 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
10937FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
10938 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
10939 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
10940 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
10941The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
10942of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
0969bd6a
EZ
10943CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
10944should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
3787e12e
GM
10945
10946Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
10947last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
10948You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
10949
10950For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
10951font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
10952following resource,
10953 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
10954the font for ASCII is generated as below:
10955 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
10956Here is the substitution rule:
10957 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
10958 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
10959 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
10960 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
10961 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
10962
10963The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
10964fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
10965that function explicitly to create a fontset.
10966
10967With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
10968like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
10969name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
10970fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
10971fontsets.
10972
10973*** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
10974defaults for a particular choice of language.
10975
10976Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
10977method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
10978visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
10979already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
10980language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
10981system for new files that you create.
10982
10983It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
10984set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
10985whole Emacs session.
10986
10987For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
10988chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
10989with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
10990
10991*** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
10992specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
10993specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
10994the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
10995coding systems that Emacs supports.
10996
10997*** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
10998lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
10999This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11000After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11001is used for *the immediately following command*.
11002
11003So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11004write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11005
11006If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11007then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11008
c3518b63 11009For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
3787e12e
GM
11010visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11011
11012*** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11013construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11014to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11015specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11016of the file.
11017
11018*** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11019the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11020code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11021translated into that character code.
11022
11023This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11024various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11025
11026By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11027
11028*** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11029the coding system for keyboard input.
11030
11031Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11032with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11033some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11034
11035By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11036
11037Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11038input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11039translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11040to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11041designed to work with terminals.
11042
11043*** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11044specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11045This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11046has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11047translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11048in the corresponding buffer.
11049
11050By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11051
11052*** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11053to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11054It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11055
11056*** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11057an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11058command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11059want to use.
11060
11061C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11062method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11063
11064*** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11065layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11066remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11067which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11068
11069*** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11070the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11071related information.
11072
11073*** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11074HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11075scripts.
11076
11077*** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11078information about the support for a particular language.
11079You specify the language as an argument.
11080
11081*** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11082the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11083first dash.
11084
11085A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11086(except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11087whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
110881 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11089
11090 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11091 B big5 (Chinese)
11092 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11093 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11094 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11095 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11096 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11097 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11098 K euc-korea (Korean)
11099 R koi8 (Russian)
11100 Q tibetan
11101 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11102 T lao
11103 T tis620 (Thai)
11104 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11105 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11106 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11107 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11108 z hz (Chinese)
11109
11110When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11111two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11112coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11113keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11114
11115*** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11116conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
11117
11118When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
11119into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
11120rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
11121Rmail files themselves.
11122
11123*** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
11124conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
11125
11126Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
11127for sending mail:
11128
11129- If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
11130- Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
11131- Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
11132 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
11133- Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
11134
11135*** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
11136to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
11137Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
11138translations.
11139
11140** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
11141of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
11142insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
11143without any conversion.
11144
11145** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
11146You can now specify any number of octal digits.
11147RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
11148any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
11149
11150** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
11151functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
11152
11153Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
11154Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
11155
11156Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
11157mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
11158
11159** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
11160complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
11161in the buffer before point.
11162
11163With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
11164symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
11165you are using.
11166
11167With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
11168just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
11169
11170** File locking works with NFS now.
11171
11172The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
11173in the same directory as FILENAME.
11174
11175This means that collision detection between two different machines now
11176works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
11177can become a bottleneck.
11178
11179The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
11180does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
11181create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
11182file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
11183rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
11184so useful that the change is worth while.
11185
11186When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
11187are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
11188collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
11189tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
11190
11191** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
11192it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
11193show-paren-mode.
11194
11195** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
11196selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
11197delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
11198
11199** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
11200within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
11201complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
11202
11203** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
11204it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
11205set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
11206
11207** Changes in View mode.
11208
11209*** Several new commands are available in View mode.
11210Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
11211
11212*** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
11213view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
11214
11215*** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
11216previous state.
11217
11218*** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
11219scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
11220
11221*** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
11222non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
11223not just the selected window.
11224
11225*** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
11226read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
11227turns View mode on or off.
11228
11229*** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
11230how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
11231delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
11232
11233** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
11234now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
11235
11236** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
11237has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
11238presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
11239which version to compare with.
11240
11241** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
11242blocks if a match is inside the block.
11243
11244The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
11245is outside the block. By customizing the variable
11246isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
11247shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
11248
11249By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
11250of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
11251blocks, all of them or none.
11252
11253** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
11254current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
11255confirmation first.
11256
11257** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
11258now changes the major mode according to that file name.
11259However, the mode will not be changed if
11260(1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
11261(2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
11262 not suitable for ordinary files, or
11263(3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
11264
11265This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
11266
11267However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
11268these commands do not change the major mode.
11269
11270** M-x occur changes.
11271
11272*** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
11273it performs a case-sensitive search.
11274
11275*** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
11276if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
11277using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
11278
11279** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
11280in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
11281window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
11282that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
11283buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
11284
11285** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
11286after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
11287appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
11288come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
11289
11290** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
11291selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
11292buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
11293
11294** Outline mode changes.
11295
11296*** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
11297
11298*** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
11299
11300** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
11301you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
11302Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
11303was already active.
11304
11305The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
11306unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
11307get confused by it.
11308
11309If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
11310set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
11311
11312** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
11313
11314*** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
11315conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
11316character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
11317including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
11318
11319The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
11320mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
11321copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
11322
11323*** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
11324are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
11325values.
11326
11327`dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
11328case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
11329`dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
11330case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
11331
11332** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
11333certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
11334can be. The default value is 30.
11335
11336** Changes in Mail mode.
11337
11338*** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
11339Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
11340composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
11341`mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
11342`sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
11343behavior.
11344
11345C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
11346compose-mail-other-frame.
11347
11348*** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
11349the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
11350replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
11351buffer that shows the original message.
11352
11353*** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
11354with separator lines around the contents.
11355
11356*** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
11357in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
11358definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
11359need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
11360
11361*** New features in the mail-complete command.
11362
11363**** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
11364for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
11365controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
11366Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
11367
11368**** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
11369to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
11370/etc/passwd.
11371
11372**** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
11373to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
11374/etc/passwd.
11375
11376** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
11377special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
11378directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
11379reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
11380
11381Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
11382when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
11383be taken to be magic.
11384
11385** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
11386files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
11387available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
11388
11389M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
11390(-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
11391
11392** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
11393suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
11394
11395In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
11396
11397new key dired.el binding old key
11398------- ---------------- -------
11399 * c dired-change-marks c
11400 * m dired-mark m
11401 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
11402 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
11403 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
11404 * u dired-unmark u
11405 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
3a426197 11406 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
3787e12e
GM
11407 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
11408 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
11409 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
11410 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
11411
11412** Rmail changes.
11413
11414*** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
11415saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
11416chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
11417each time you run it.
11418
11419*** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
11420whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
11421
11422*** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
11423messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
11424means to move in the opposite direction.
11425
11426*** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
11427you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
11428
11429*** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
11430just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
11431It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
11432can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
11433for output.
11434
11435** Gnus changes.
11436
11437*** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
11438
11439*** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
11440Gnus.
11441
11442*** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
11443`and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
11444
11445*** Article washing status can be displayed in the
11446article mode line.
11447
11448*** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
11449
11450*** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
11451
11452(setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
11453
11454*** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
11455are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
11456`gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
11457
11458*** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
11459
11460*** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
11461
11462*** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
11463See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
11464
11465*** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
11466Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
11467used to pick articles.
11468
11469*** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
11470another have been added.
11471
11472 `M-x gnus-change-server'
11473
11474*** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
11475generating lines in buffers.
11476
11477*** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
3a426197 11478`C-M-_'.
3787e12e
GM
11479
11480*** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
11481
11482*** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
11483
11484 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
11485
11486*** Scores can be decayed.
11487
11488 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
11489
11490*** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
11491Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
11492
11493*** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
11494the native server.
11495
11496 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
11497
11498*** A new command for reading collections of documents
3a426197 11499(nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
3787e12e
GM
11500
11501*** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
11502
11503*** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
11504even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
11505
11506*** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
11507(DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
11508
11509 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
11510 a group.
11511
11512*** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
11513sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
11514
11515 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
11516
11517*** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
11518
11519 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
11520
11521*** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
11522
11523 Use the `Y c' command.
11524
11525*** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
11526
11527*** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
11528
11529 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
11530
11531*** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
11532from incoming mail before saving the mail.
11533
11534 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
11535
11536*** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
11537
11538*** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
11539the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
11540
11541 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
11542
11543Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
11544and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
11545from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
11546hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
11547this issue.)
11548
11549Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
11550automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
11551particular news group. This can be done by:
11552
11553 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
11554
11555Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
11556of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
11557"XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
11558system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
11559for reading and posting).
11560
11561CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
11562 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
11563Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
11564newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
11565there.
11566
11567Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
11568default. Here are some of these default settings:
11569
11570 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
11571 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
11572 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
11573 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
11574 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
11575
11576When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
11577the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
11578
11579** CC mode changes.
11580
11581*** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
11582code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
11583values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
11584this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
11585Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
11586loaded.
11587
11588If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
11589Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
11590style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
11591share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
11592c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
11593must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
11594
11595*** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
11596of the current buffer.
11597
11598*** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
11599it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
11600of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
11601
11602*** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
11603style that the Python developers like.
11604
11605*** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
11606This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
11607just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
11608
11609** VC Changes [new]
11610
9614842d 11611*** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
3787e12e
GM
11612name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
11613directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
11614
11615This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
11616master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
11617developers.
11618
11619You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
11620RET in a buffer visiting that file.
11621
11622*** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
11623other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
11624writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
11625calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
11626
11627*** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
11628version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
11629
11630** Calendar changes.
11631
9614842d
JW
11632*** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
11633subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
11634you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
11635following/previous years.
11636
11637*** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
11638the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
11639calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
11640each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
11641calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
11642supposed attribute of God.
3787e12e
GM
11643
11644** ps-print changes
11645
2261f14e
GM
11646There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
11647layout.
3787e12e 11648
2261f14e 11649*** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
3787e12e 11650
2261f14e
GM
11651Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
11652be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
11653printer system has this behavior, set variable
11654`ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
3787e12e 11655
2261f14e
GM
11656If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
11657blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
a5d03456 11658very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
3787e12e 11659
2261f14e
GM
11660The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
11661setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
3787e12e 11662
2261f14e
GM
11663 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
11664 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
11665 printing for your printer.
3787e12e 11666
2261f14e
GM
11667 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
11668 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
3787e12e 11669
2261f14e
GM
11670 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
11671 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
3787e12e 11672
2261f14e
GM
11673The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
11674opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
11675`ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
11676bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
11677ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
11678This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
11679The default value is nil.
3787e12e 11680
2261f14e
GM
11681The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
11682properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
3787e12e 11683
2261f14e
GM
11684 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
11685 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
11686 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
11687 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
11688 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
11689 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
11690 color). The default is 0 ("black").
3787e12e 11691
2261f14e
GM
11692 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
11693 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
11694
11695 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
11696 The default is 0 ("black").
11697
11698 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
11699 The default is 0 ("black").
11700
11701 border-width Specify the border width.
11702 The default is 0.4.
11703
11704Any other property is ignored.
11705
11706Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
11707`ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
11708documentation).
11709
11710Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
11711`ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
11712`ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
11713`ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
11714`ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
11715controlling headers.
3787e12e 11716
2261f14e
GM
11717*** Color management (subgroup)
11718
11719If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
11720color.
11721
11722*** Face Management (subgroup)
3787e12e 11723
2261f14e
GM
11724If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
11725set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
11726background should be used. Valid values are:
11727
11728 t always use face background color.
11729 nil never use face background color.
11730 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
11731
11732*** N-up printing (subgroup)
11733
11734The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
11735sheet of paper.
11736
11737The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
11738between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
11739
11740If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
11741each page.
11742
11743The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
11744on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
11745`ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
11746
11747 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
11748 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
11749 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
3787e12e 11750
2261f14e
GM
11751 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
11752 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
11753 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
11754
11755 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
11756 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
11757 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
11758
11759 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
11760 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
11761 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
3787e12e 11762
2261f14e
GM
11763Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
11764
11765*** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
3787e12e 11766
2261f14e
GM
11767The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
11768RGB color.
11769
11770The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
11771continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
11772to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
11773
11774 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
11775 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11776 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11777 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11778 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11779 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
11780 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
11781 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
11782 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11783 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11784 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11785 10 + 10 +
11786 11 + 11 +
11787 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11788 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11789 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
11790 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
11791 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
11792 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11793 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11794 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
11795 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
11796 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
11797 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
11798 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
11799 22 + 22 +
11800 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
11801
11802Any other value is treated as `nil'.
11803
11804
11805*** Printer management (subgroup)
11806
11807The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
11808some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
11809`ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
11810utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
11811to "-P".
11812
11813The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
11814paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
11815non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
11816
11817The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
11818should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
11819do so.
11820
11821*** Page settings (subgroup)
11822
11823If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
11824error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
11825indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
11826instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
11827the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
11828by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
11829`setpagedevice'.
11830
11831The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
11832printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
11833`upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
11834
11835The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
11836it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
11837integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
11838specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
11839is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
11840its TO, are ignored.
11841
11842The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
11843pages. Valid values are:
11844
11845 nil print all pages.
11846
11847 `even-page' print only even pages.
11848
11849 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
11850
11851 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
11852 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
11853 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
11854 print only the even sheet of paper.
11855
11856 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
11857 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
11858 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
11859 only the odd sheet of paper.
11860
11861Any other value is treated as nil.
11862
11863If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
11864are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
11865`ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
11866
11867 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
11868
11869and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
11870`ps-n-up-printing', we get:
11871
11872`ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
11873 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
11874 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
11875 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
11876 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
11877 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
11878 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
11879
11880`ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
11881 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
11882 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
11883 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
11884 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
11885 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
11886 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
11887
11888*** Miscellany (subgroup)
11889
11890The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
11891messages should be sent.
11892
11893It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
11894front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
11895`ps-user-defined-prologue'.
11896
11897The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
11898
11899The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
11900points for line numbers.
11901
11902The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
11903numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
11904
11905The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
11906line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
11907to 2, the printing will look like:
11908
11909 1 one line
11910 one line
11911 3 one line
11912 one line
11913 5 one line
11914 one line
11915 ...
11916
11917Valid values are:
11918
11919integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
11920 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
11921 is used.
11922
11923`zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
11924 zebra stripe is to be printed.
11925
11926Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
11927
11928The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
11929the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
11930`ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
119313, the output will look like:
11932
11933 one line
11934 one line
11935 3 one line
11936 one line
11937 one line
11938 6 one line
11939 one line
11940 one line
11941 9 one line
11942 one line
11943 ...
11944
11945The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
11946where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
11947
11948The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
11949for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
11950`ps-font-size').
11951
11952The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
11953in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
11954`ps-font-size').
11955
11956The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
11957
11958The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
11959start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
3787e12e
GM
11960
11961** hideshow changes.
11962
11963*** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
11964C++, ; for lisp).
11965
11966*** Support for java-mode added.
11967
11968*** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
11969in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
11970
f3780fe4 11971*** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
3787e12e
GM
11972the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
11973way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
11974
11975*** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
11976robust and a lot faster.
11977
11978*** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
11979
11980*** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
11981to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
11982documentation for more details.
11983
11984** Changes in Enriched mode.
11985
11986*** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
11987filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
11988of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
11989use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
11990the next time unless the fill-column is different.
11991
11992*** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
11993distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
11994as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
11995as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
11996
11997** Font Lock mode
11998
11999*** Custom support
12000
12001The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12002font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12003faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12004group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12005your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12006consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12007
12008You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12009
12010*** Maximum decoration
12011
12012Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12013default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12014of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12015supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12016to get the old behavior.
12017
12018*** New support
12019
12020Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12021
12022Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12023support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12024
12025*** Configurable support
12026
12027Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12028additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12029c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12030java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12031list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12032of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12033convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12034
12035Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12036way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12037it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12038
12039*** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12040
12041You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12042highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12043for any mode.
12044
12045For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12046
12047 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12048
12049in your ~/.emacs.
12050
12051*** New faces
12052
12053Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12054font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12055distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12056to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12057
12058*** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12059
12060The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12061cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12062same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12063
12064*** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12065
12066The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12067according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12068the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12069non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12070refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12071the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
dfd67a62 12072Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
3787e12e
GM
12073
12074This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12075For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12076this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12077refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12078containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
12079the command M-g M-g (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
12080
12081As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12082
12083Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12084Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12085Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12086new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12087
12088If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12089settings.
12090
12091** Ada mode changes.
12092
12093*** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12094If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12095procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12096you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12097stubs.
12098
12099*** There are two new commands:
12100 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12101 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12102
12103The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12104`ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12105`ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12106
12107*** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12108is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12109Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12110
12111*** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12112formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12113places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12114space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12115
12116** Scheme mode changes.
12117
12118*** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
12119mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
12120for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
12121with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
12122have any effect.
12123
12124If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
12125still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
12126scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
12127variables as buffer-local variables.
12128
12129*** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
12130Use M-x dsssl-mode.
12131
12132** Changes to the emacsclient program
12133
12134*** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
12135USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
12136associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
12137can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
12138
12139*** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
12140it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
12141buffer in Emacs.
12142
12143*** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
12144use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
12145ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
12146option takes precedence.
12147
12148** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
12149constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
12150(in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
12151
12152** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
12153which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
12154the current defun.
12155
12156** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
12157following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
12158
12159** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
12160and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
12161necessary).
12162
12163** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
12164if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
12165these register values no longer become completely useless.
12166If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
12167asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
12168it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
12169
12170** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
12171example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
12172be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
12173you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
12174
12175You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
12176variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
12177file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
12178revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
12179only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
12180
12181** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
12182since it applies only to the current frame.
12183
12184** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
12185file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
12186and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
12187
12188This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
12189multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
12190variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
12191tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
12192instead of just the file you are editing.
12193
12194** RefTeX mode
12195
12196RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
12197and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
12198different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
12199multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
12200turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
12201
12202C-c ( reftex-label
12203 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
12204 knows which kind of label is needed.
12205
12206C-c ) reftex-reference
12207 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
12208 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
12209
12210C-c [ reftex-citation
12211 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
12212 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
12213
12214C-c & reftex-view-crossref
12215 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
12216
12217C-c = reftex-toc
12218 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
12219 can quickly jump to every section.
12220
12221Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
12222commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
12223Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
12224reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
12225C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
12226
12227** Changes in BibTeX mode.
12228
12229*** Info documentation is now available.
12230
12231*** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
12232both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
12233
12234*** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
12235bibtex-user-optional-fields.
12236
12237*** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
12238(use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
12239
12240*** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
12241entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
12242appropriate functions.
12243
12244*** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
3a426197 12245entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
3787e12e
GM
12246
12247*** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
12248been cleaned.
12249
12250*** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
12251bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
12252
12253*** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
12254shall be delimited.
12255
12256*** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
12257bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
12258bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
12259
12260*** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
12261field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
12262prefixed with `ALT'.
12263
12264*** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
12265bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
12266formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
12267documentation).
12268
12269*** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
12270documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
12271for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
12272
12273*** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
12274comma should be inserted at end of last field.
12275
12276*** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
12277alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
12278signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
12279
12280*** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
12281
12282*** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
12283
12284*** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
12285from alien sources.
12286
12287*** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
12288to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
12289crossref entries.
12290
12291*** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
12292region.
12293
12294*** Added support for imenu.
12295
12296*** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
12297of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
12298`compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
12299`next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
12300
12301*** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
12302from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
12303
12304** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
12305
12306** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
12307
12308** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
12309functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
12310Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
12311as an argument.
12312
12313When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
12314and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
12315
12316** browse-url changes
12317
12318*** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
12319Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
12320(browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
12321non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
12322customization variables.
12323
12324*** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
12325
12326*** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
12327lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
12328(e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
12329
12330** Changes in Ediff
12331
12332*** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
12333pops up the Info file for this command.
12334
12335*** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
12336the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
12337merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
12338directories).
12339
12340*** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
12341and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
12342files in the same directory.
12343
12344*** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
12345The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
12346related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
12347
12348** Changes in Viper
12349
12350*** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
12351*** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
12352 instead of vip-.
12353*** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
12354*** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
12355Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
12356*** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
12357*** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
12358*** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
12359color when Viper is in insert state.
12360*** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
12361Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
12362viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
12363
12364** Etags changes.
12365
12366*** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
12367default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
12368Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
12369variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
12370not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
12371
12372*** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
12373
12374*** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
12375constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
12376
12377*** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
12378recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
12379In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
12380
12381*** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
12382C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
12383recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
12384methods and protocols.
12385
12386*** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
12387.cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
12388column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
12389paragraph name.
12390
12391*** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
12392an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
12393at least M times and as many as N times.
12394
12395** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
12396in files has changed slightly.
12397
12398With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
12399time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
12400This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
12401with old time-stamp-format values.
12402
12403In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
12404(`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
12405This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
12406reasons.
12407
12408In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
12409natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
12410fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
12411(`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
12412time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
12413specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
12414
12415Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
12416case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
12417truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
12418
12419The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
12420being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
12421future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
12422recommended now will continue to work then.
12423
12424See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
12425details.
12426
12427** There are some additional major modes:
12428
12429dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
12430m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
12431meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
12432
12433** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
12434copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
12435into Emacs.
12436
12437** New Lisp packages include:
12438
12439*** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
12440
12441*** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
12442be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
12443
12444*** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
12445
12446*** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
12447in shell buffers.
12448
12449*** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
12450See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
12451and `elint-defun'.
12452
12453*** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
12454meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
12455ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
12456strings or comments.
12457
12458These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
12459abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
12460you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
12461insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
12462at these points.
12463
12464*** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
12465can visit them by short forms of their names.
12466
12467*** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
12468Emacs Lisp function at point.
12469
12470*** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
12471
12472*** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
12473switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
12474
12475*** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
12476
12477*** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
12478
12479*** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
12480
12481*** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
12482from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
12483
12484*** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
12485You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
12486inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
12487original place after inserting the copy.
12488
12489*** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
12490on the buffer.
12491
12492You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
12493velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
12494(with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
12495
12496Enable mouse-drag with:
12497 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
12498-or-
12499 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
12500
12501*** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
12502mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
12503
12504*** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
12505It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
12506
12507*** ogonek
12508
12509The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
12510Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
12511platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
12512TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
12513ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
12514prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
12515instance) and vice versa.
12516
12517To use this package load it using
12518 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
12519Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
12520 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
12521 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
12522The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
12523ways of customization in `.emacs'.
12524
12525*** Interface to ph.
12526
12527Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
12528
12529The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
12530services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
12531these servers.
12532
12533*** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
12534
12535*** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
12536You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
12537while the real cursor does not move.
12538
12539*** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
12540for visiting your favorite web sites.
12541
12542*** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
12543so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
12544
12545** movemail change
12546
12547Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
12548mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
12549supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
12550user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
12551
12552This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
05197f40 12553\f
3787e12e
GM
12554* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
12555
12556** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
12557
12558Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
12559end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
12560Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
12561file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
12562file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
12563
12564To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
12565C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
12566coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
12567specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
12568LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
12569save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
05197f40 12570\f
3787e12e
GM
12571* Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
12572
12573** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
12574Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
12575vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
12576Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
12577
12578** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
12579to start with w32- instead of win32-.
12580
12581In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
12582don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
12583"win".
12584
12585** Basic Lisp changes
12586
12587*** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
12588evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
12589
12590*** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
12591be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
12592or by the user.
12593
12594The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
12595
12596*** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
12597
12598(when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
12599(unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
12600
12601*** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
12602usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
12603its argument.
12604
12605*** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
12606
12607*** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
12608
12609*** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
12610
12611*** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
12612error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
12613include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
12614`format' function.
12615
12616*** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
12617or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
12618whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
12619
12620*** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
12621either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
12622adding one of these suffixes.
12623
12624*** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
12625which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
12626If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
12627
12628We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
12629because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
12630
12631*** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
12632
12633*** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
12634You must load the `cl' library to define it.
12635
12636*** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
12637conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
12638
12639 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
12640
12641BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
12642BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
12643
12644*** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
12645choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
12646restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
12647works using `save-current-buffer'.
12648
12649*** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
12650write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
12651of the last form.
12652
12653*** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
12654which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
12655last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
12656as the last form.
12657
12658*** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
12659characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
12660matches.
12661
12662For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
12663
12664*** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
12665with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
12666Then it returns that string.
12667
12668For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
12669
12670(with-output-to-string
12671 (princ "The buffer is ")
12672 (princ (buffer-name)))
12673
12674returns "The buffer is foo".
12675
12676** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
12677is non-nil.
12678
12679These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
12680buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
12681characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
12682
12683*** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
12684a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
12685
12686Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
12687character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
12688Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
12689position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
12690characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
12691 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
12692
12693ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
12694Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
12695non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
12696characters".
12697
12698The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
12699through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
12700"leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
12701range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
12702leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
12703
12704*** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
12705(forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
12706multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
12707character, which may be more than one buffer position.
12708
12709This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
12710always one buffer position, need to be changed.
12711
12712However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
12713
12714*** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
12715because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
12716have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
12717the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
12718guaranteed.
12719
12720*** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
12721between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
12722character).
12723
12724When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
12725
12726 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
12727 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
12728 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
12729 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
12730 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
12731
12732*** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
12733
12734*** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
12735`length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
12736more than the number of characters.
12737
12738You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
12739it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
12740\xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
12741is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
12742follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
12743newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
12744
12745*** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
12746and returns a string containing those characters.
12747
12748*** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
12749(sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
12750counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
12751character, sref signals an error.
12752
12753*** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
12754in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
12755string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
12756
12757*** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
12758in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
12759region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
12760
12761*** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
12762the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
12763to a vector of the characters in it.
12764
12765*** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
12766of a string. You call it as follows:
12767
12768 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
12769
12770This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
12771STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
12772This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
12773Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
12774it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
12775
12776*** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
12777if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
12778
12779*** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
12780if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
12781
12782*** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
12783to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
12784not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
12785which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
12786
12787(truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
12788
12789This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
12790
12791The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
12792If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
12793are not included in the resulting value.
12794
12795The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
12796at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
12797WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
12798is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
12799
12800If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
12801place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
12802character extends across that column), then the padding character
12803PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
12804string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
12805column START-COLUMN.
12806
12807*** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
12808the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
12809necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
12810difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
12811changed text, before the change.
12812
12813*** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
12814sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
12815one character set for each script, not for each language.
12816
12817**** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
12818
12819**** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
12820
12821**** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
12822set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
12823
12824**** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
12825name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
12826which identify the character within that character set.
12827
12828**** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
12829byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
12830opposite of split-char.
12831
12832**** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
12833of all the characters between BEG and END.
12834
12835**** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
12836of all the characters in a string.
12837
12838*** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
12839and specifying coding systems.
12840
12841**** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
12842system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
12843of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
12844(Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
12845and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
12846as what to do about code conversion.)
12847
12848**** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
12849name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
12850
12851**** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
12852for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
12853except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
12854
12855Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
12856which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
12857to match against a file name.
12858
12859VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
12860a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
12861decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
12862to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
12863systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
12864specifies the coding system for encoding.
12865
12866If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
12867or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
12868
12869**** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
12870the coding system to use for network sockets.
12871
12872Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
12873which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
12874either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
12875service names.
12876
12877VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
12878a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
12879decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
12880to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
12881systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
12882specifies the coding system for encoding.
12883
12884If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
12885or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
12886
12887**** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
12888for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
12889except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
12890start the subprocess.
12891
12892**** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
12893systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
12894when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
12895(OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
12896to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
12897
12898**** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
12899coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
12900subprocess.
12901
12902It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
12903but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
12904start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
12905connection permanently or until overridden.
12906
12907The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
12908file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
12909network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
12910coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
12911It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
12912system for one operation at a time.
12913
12914**** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
12915files, subprocesses or network connections.
12916
12917**** The function process-coding-system tells you what
12918coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
12919The value is a cons cell,
12920 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
12921where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
12922the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
12923input to the subprocess.
12924
12925**** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
12926change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
12927
12928** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
12929customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
12930you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
12931
12932You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
12933variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
12934information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
12935legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
12936customization.
12937
12938Thus, instead of writing
12939
12940 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
12941 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
12942
12943you would now write this:
12944
12945 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
12946 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
12947 :type 'boolean
12948 :group foo)
12949
12950The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
12951two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
12952describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
12953for a description of them.
12954
12955The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
12956should belong to. You define a new group like this:
12957
12958 (defgroup ispell nil
12959 "Spell checking using Ispell."
12960 :group 'processes)
12961
12962The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
12963group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
12964but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
12965to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
12966second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
12967
12968Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
12969package should have just one group; a more complex package should
12970have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
12971package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
12972first-level subgroups.
12973
12974** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
12975
12976This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
12977separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
12978
12979** easy-mmode
12980
12981The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
12982developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
12983only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
12984predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
12985`easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
12986`easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
12987
12988** Text property changes
12989
12990*** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
12991text property.
12992
12993*** The new functions next-char-property-change and
12994previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
12995place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
12996functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
12997starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
12998
12999If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13000LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13001of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13002position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13003
13004*** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13005value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13006is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13007
13008** Changes in invisibility features
13009
13010*** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13011hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13012is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13013should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13014would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13015make the overlay visible.
13016
13017During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13018invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13019needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13020which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13021the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13022t when it should hide it.
13023
13024*** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13025
13026Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13027invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13028and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13029Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13030manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13031Here is an example of how to do this:
13032
13033 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13034 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13035 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13036 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13037
13038 ...
13039 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13040
13041 ...
13042 ;; When done with the overlays:
13043 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13044 ;; Or respectively:
13045 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13046
13047** Changes in syntax parsing.
13048
13049*** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13050`parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13051obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13052`parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13053
13054If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13055is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13056used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13057
13058When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13059character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13060
13061 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13062 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13063
13064 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13065 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13066 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13067
13068 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13069 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13070 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13071 determine the syntax type of the character.
13072
13073 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13074 of the current buffer.
13075
13076*** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13077value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13078for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13079
13080*** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13081and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13082only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13083character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13084another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13085
13086These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13087text property.
13088
13089*** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13090arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13091of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13092
13093*** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13094(and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13095element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13096nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13097string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13098
13099*** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13100syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13101`font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13102
13103** Changes in face features
13104
13105*** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13106if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13107
13108*** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13109of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13110
13111*** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13112set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13113
13114*** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13115set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13116
13117*** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
13118by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
13119and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
13120the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
13121overlay property).
13122
13123This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
13124arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
13125
13126** Changes in file-handling functions
13127
13128*** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
13129directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
13130they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
13131is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
13132
13133This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
13134begins with ~.
13135
13136*** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
13137it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
13138
13139*** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
13140the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
13141
13142*** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
13143as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
13144
13145*** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
13146character code conversion as well as other things.
13147
13148Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
13149(formerly it did not).
13150
13151*** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
13152environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
13153
13154*** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
13155instead of constant strings.
13156
13157*** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
13158to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
13159any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
13160
13161substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
13162in the same way as before.
13163
13164*** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
13165The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
13166which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
13167
13168*** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
13169error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
13170else, and returns nil.
13171
13172*** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
13173directory cannot be listed.
13174
13175** Changes in minibuffer input
13176
13177*** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
13178read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
13179additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
13180argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
13181ways:
13182
13183 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
13184 It is available through the history command M-n.
13185
13186*** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
13187read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
13188argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
13189minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
13190enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
13191
13192In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
13193argument in this way.
13194
13195*** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
13196from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
13197minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
13198
13199** Echo area features
13200
13201*** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
13202echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
13203minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
13204after the echo area is cleared.
13205
13206*** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
13207in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
13208
13209** Keyboard input features
13210
13211*** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
13212set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
13213
13214*** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
13215received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
13216by keyboard macros.
13217
13218** Frame-related changes
13219
13220*** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
13221creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
13222hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
13223
13224*** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
13225the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
13226has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
13227
13228*** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
13229selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
13230value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
13231in the selected frame.
13232
13233*** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
13234is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
13235which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
13236
13237** X Windows features
13238
13239*** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
13240x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
13241x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
13242
13243*** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
13244The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
13245
13246*** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
13247MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
13248A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
13249
13250If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
13251it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
13252
13253** Subprocess features
13254
13255*** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
13256functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
13257automatically.
13258
13259*** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
13260and returns the output from the command as a string.
13261
13262*** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
13263and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
13264
13265** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
13266does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
13267
13268** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
13269at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
13270goes after the other menu items.
13271
13272** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
13273of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
13274around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
13275are in use.
13276
13277The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
13278series of several changes--if that seems safe.
13279
13280Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
13281after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
13282form.
13283
13284** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
13285is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
13286but its hook is still run.
13287
13288** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
13289for errors that are handled by condition-case.
13290
13291If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
13292regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
13293useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
13294
13295This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
13296are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
13297filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
13298warned.
13299
13300** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
13301way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
13302
13303** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
13304integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
13305functions like display-time.
13306
13307** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
13308name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
13309
13310** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
13311can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
13312is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
13313
13314** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
13315if there is an error in compilation.
13316
13317** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
13318switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
13319argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
13320they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
13321
13322** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
13323Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
13324the *scratch* buffer.
13325
13326** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
13327The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
13328where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
13329e.g., in Font Lock mode.
13330
13331** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
13332and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
13333It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
13334
13335** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
13336using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
13337variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
13338and compose-mail-other-frame.
13339
13340** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
13341can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
13342full name of the specified user will be returned.
13343
13344** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
13345of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
13346where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
13347in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
13348option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
13349files at all.
13350
13351** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
13352and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
13353width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
13354the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
13355
13356For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
13357minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
13358with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
13359is how %S normally pads to two positions.
13360
13361** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
13362
13363** imenu.el changes.
13364
13365You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
13366item from menu created by imenu.
13367
13368An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
13369#include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
13370select one of those items.
05197f40 13371\f
3787e12e 13372* For older news, see the file ONEWS
a933dad1
DL
13373
13374----------------------------------------------------------------------
13375Copyright information:
13376
175573ac 13377Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
a933dad1
DL
13378
13379 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
13380 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
13381 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
13382 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
13383
13384 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
13385 of this document, or of portions of it,
13386 under the above conditions, provided also that they
13387 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
05197f40 13388\f
a933dad1
DL
13389Local variables:
13390mode: outline
13391paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
13392end:
ab5796a9
MB
13393
13394arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793